]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - ld/ld.texi
ld: Support input section description keyword: REVERSE
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
d87bef3a 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
d87bef3a 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c 87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
3ac23310 88\hfill nickc\@redhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
d87bef3a 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
bf6d8037 129* Plugins:: Linker Plugins
252b5132
RH
130@ifset GENERIC
131* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132@end ifset
133@ifclear GENERIC
134@ifset H8300
135* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
137@ifset Renesas
138* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 139@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
140@ifset ARM
141* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
143@ifset M68HC11
144* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
146@ifset HPPA
147* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
149@ifset M68K
150* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151@end ifset
833794fc
MR
152@ifset MIPS
153* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
155@ifset POWERPC
156* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157@end ifset
158@ifset POWERPC64
159* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
161@ifset S/390
162* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
164@ifset SPU
165* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
167@ifset TICOFF
168* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
170@ifset WIN32
171* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
173@ifset XTENSA
174* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175@end ifset
252b5132
RH
176@end ifclear
177@ifclear SingleFormat
178* BFD:: BFD
179@end ifclear
180@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 184* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 185* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 186@end menu
84ec0e6d 187@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
188
189@node Overview
190@chapter Overview
191
192@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 194
0879a67a 195@ifset man
0285c67d 196@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 197ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
198@c man end
199
200@c man begin SEEALSO
201ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203@file{ld}.
204@c man end
205@end ifset
206
207@c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
ff5dcc92 209@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 210their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 211compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 212
ff5dcc92 213@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
214a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
0285c67d
NC
217@ifset man
218@c For the man only
ece2d90e 219This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
220@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
222@end ifset
223
252b5132 224@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
225This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
227write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230@end ifclear
231
232Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 235@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
236(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
0285c67d
NC
238@c man end
239
252b5132
RH
240@node Invocation
241@chapter Invocation
242
0285c67d
NC
243@c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
ff5dcc92 245The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
246and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
0285c67d
NC
249@c man end
250
252b5132
RH
251@ifset UsesEnvVars
252@menu
a05a5b64 253* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
254* Environment:: Environment Variables
255@end menu
256
257@node Options
a05a5b64 258@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
259@end ifset
260
261@cindex command line
262@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
263
264@c man begin OPTIONS
265
252b5132
RH
266The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 269For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
270object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273@smallexample
274ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275@end smallexample
276
ff5dcc92 277This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
278result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
ff5dcc92 282Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
283point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
288occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290noted in the descriptions below.
291
292@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
293Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
297
298Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302message @samp{No input files}.
303
36f63dca 304If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
305assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
310@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
315
316For options whose names are a single letter,
317option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319option that requires them.
320
321For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 322precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 323@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 324this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 325only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
326@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328output.
329
330Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335accepted.
252b5132 336
36f63dca 337Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 338(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
339prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
341
342@smallexample
2509a395 343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
344@end smallexample
345
346This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
347silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354@smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356@end smallexample
4e53152f 357
a05a5b64 358Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
359linker:
360
ff5dcc92 361@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 362@include at-file.texi
dff70155 363
2509a395
SL
364@kindex -a @var{keyword}
365@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
366This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
7ee314fa
AM
372@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 379it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 380This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 381interface.
7ee314fa 382
252b5132
RH
383@ifclear SingleFormat
384@cindex binary input format
385@kindex -b @var{format}
386@kindex --format=@var{format}
387@cindex input format
388@cindex input format
389@item -b @var{input-format}
390@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
391@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 393@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 394that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 395configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 396to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
397default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401@xref{BFD}.
402
403You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405linking object files of different formats), by including
406@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 407particular format.
252b5132
RH
408
409The default format is taken from the environment variable
410@code{GNUTARGET}.
411@ifset UsesEnvVars
412@xref{Environment}.
413@end ifset
414You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
415@code{TARGET};
416@ifclear man
417see @ref{Format Commands}.
418@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
419@end ifclear
420
421@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423@cindex compatibility, MRI
424@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 426For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 427files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
428@ifclear man
429@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430@end ifclear
431@ifset man
432the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433@end ifset
434Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 435the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
436scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
438specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440@cindex common allocation
441@kindex -d
442@kindex -dc
443@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 444@item -d
252b5132
RH
445@itemx -dc
446@itemx -dp
447These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
7ee314fa
AM
453@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 462The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 463
2d5783fa
NC
464@kindex --enable-linker-version
465@item --enable-linker-version
466Enables the @code{LINKER_VERSION} linker script directive, described
467in @ref{Output Section Data}. If this directive is used in a linker
468script and this option has been enabled then a string containing the
469linker version will be inserted at the current point.
470
471Note - this location of this option on the linker command line is
472significant. It will only affect linker scripts that come after it on
473the command line, or which are built into the linker.
474
475@kindex --disable-linker-version
476@item --disable-linker-version
477Disables the @code{LINKER_VERSION} linker script directive, so that it
478does not insert a version string. This is the default.
479
abf874aa
CL
480@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
481@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
482This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
483fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
484section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
485error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
486several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
487section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
488sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
489
490@smallexample
491 MEMORY @{
93cda40b
NC
492 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
493 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
494 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
abf874aa
CL
495 @}
496 SECTIONS @{
497 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
498 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
94ffdb59 499 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM3
abf874aa
CL
500 @}
501
502 with input sections:
503 .data.1: size 8
504 .data.2: size 0x10
505 .data.3: size 4
506
507 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
508 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
509@end smallexample
510
511This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
512the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
513
514@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
515@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
516This option enables warnings when
517@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
518matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
519discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
520output region.
521
252b5132
RH
522@cindex entry point, from command line
523@kindex -e @var{entry}
524@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 525@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
526@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
527Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
528program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
529named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
530and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
531base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
532@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
533and other ways of specifying the entry point.
534
b58f81ae
DJ
535@kindex --exclude-libs
536@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
537Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 538exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
539@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
540automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
541port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
542explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
543option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
544be treated as hidden.
545
e1c37eb5
DK
546@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
547@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
548Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
549should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
550into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
551may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
552used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
553the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
554match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
555command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
556of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
557regardless of this option.
558
252b5132
RH
559@cindex dynamic symbol table
560@kindex -E
561@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 562@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
563@item -E
564@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
565@itemx --no-export-dynamic
566When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
567option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
568all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
569set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
570
571If you do not use either of these options (or use the
572@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
573dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
574referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
575
576If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
577back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
578dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
579linking the program itself.
580
55255dae 581You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 582be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 583See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 584
8b747e1a
DK
585Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
586support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
587the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
588
37a141bf
FS
589@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
590@cindex export dynamic symbol
591@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
592When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
593@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
594shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
595bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
596no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
597@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
598on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
599
600@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
601@cindex export dynamic symbol list
602@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
603Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
604The format of the file is the same as the version node without
605scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
606
36f63dca 607@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
608@cindex big-endian objects
609@cindex endianness
610@kindex -EB
611@item -EB
612Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
613
614@cindex little-endian objects
615@kindex -EL
616@item -EL
617Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 618@end ifclear
252b5132 619
2509a395
SL
620@kindex -f @var{name}
621@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
622@item -f @var{name}
623@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
624When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
625to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
626table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
627symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
628
629If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
630run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
631the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
632first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
633@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
634in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
635Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
636implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 637machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
638
639This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
640will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
641
2509a395
SL
642@kindex -F @var{name}
643@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 644@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 645@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
646When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
647the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
648of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
649on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
650
651If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
652run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
653dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
654filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
655found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
656used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
657@var{name}.
658
ff5dcc92 659Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 660toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
661object files.
662@ifclear SingleFormat
663The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 664@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 665@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
666environment variable.
667@end ifclear
668The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
669creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 670
3dbf70a2 671@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
672@kindex -fini=@var{name}
673@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
674When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
675executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
676address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
677the function to call.
678
252b5132
RH
679@kindex -g
680@item -g
681Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
682
2509a395
SL
683@kindex -G @var{value}
684@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 685@cindex object size
2509a395 686@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
687@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
688Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
689@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 690MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
691sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
692
693@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 694@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 695@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 696@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
697@itemx -soname=@var{name}
698When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
699the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
700which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
701linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
010e444b 702field rather than using the file name given to the linker.
252b5132
RH
703
704@kindex -i
705@cindex incremental link
706@item -i
707Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
708
3dbf70a2 709@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
710@kindex -init=@var{name}
711@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
712When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
713executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
714of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
715function to call.
716
252b5132 717@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 718@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 719@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 720@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
721@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
722Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
723list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
724If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 725will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 726will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 727
ff5dcc92 728On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
729files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
730and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
731called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
732@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
733indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
734to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
735@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
736
737The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
738specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
739was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
740command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
741archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
742the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
743
ff5dcc92 744See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
745archives multiple times.
746
747You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
748
749@ifset GENERIC
750This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 751if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
752behaviour of the AIX linker.
753@end ifset
754
755@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 756@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 757@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 758@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 759@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
760Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
761for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
762option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
763in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
764on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 765@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
766order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
767how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
768option is specified.
252b5132 769
3aa2d05a
NC
770If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
771prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
772@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 773
252b5132
RH
774@ifset UsesEnvVars
775The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 776@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
777some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
778@end ifset
779
780The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
781@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
782at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
783
784@cindex emulation
785@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 786@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
787Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
788emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
789
790If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
791@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
792
793Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
794configured.
795
fb221fba
NC
796@cindex remapping inputs
797@kindex --remap-inputs=@file{pattern}=@file{filename}
798@kindex --remap-inputs-file=@file{file}
799@item --remap-inputs=@file{pattern}=@file{filename}
800@itemx --remap-inputs-file=@file{file}
801These options allow the names of input files to be changed before the
802linker attempts to open them. The option
803@option{--remap-inputs=foo.o=bar.o} will cause any attempt to load a
804file called @file{foo.o} to instead try to load a file called
805@file{bar.o}. Wildcard patterns are permitted in the first filename,
806so @option{--remap-inputs=foo*.o=bar.o} will rename any input file that
807matches @file{foo*.o} to @file{bar.o}.
808
809An alternative form of the option
810@option{--remap-inputs-file=filename} allows the remappings to be read
811from a file. Each line in the file can contain a single remapping.
812Blank lines are ignored. Anything from a hash character (@samp{#}) to
813the end of a line is considered to be a comment and is also ignored.
814The mapping pattern can be separated from the filename by whitespace
815or an equals (@samp{=}) character.
816
817The options can be specified multiple times. Their contents
818accumulate. The remappings will be processed in the order in which
819they occur on the command line, and if they come from a file, in the
820order in which they occur in the file. If a match is made, no further
821checking for that filename will be performed.
822
823If the replacement filename is @file{/dev/null} or just @file{NUL}
824then the remapping will actually cause the input file to be ignored.
825This can be a convenient way to experiment with removing input files
826from a complicated build environment.
827
828Note that this option is position dependent and only affects filenames
829that come after it on the command line. Thus:
830
831@smallexample
832 ld foo.o --remap-inputs=foo.o=bar.o
833@end smallexample
834
835Will have no effect, whereas:
836
837@smallexample
838 ld --remap-inputs=foo.o=bar.o foo.o
839@end smallexample
840
841Will rename the input file @file{foo.o} to @file{bar.o}.
842
843Note - these options also affect files referenced by @emph{INPUT}
844statements in linker scripts. But since linker scripts are processed
845after the entire command line is read, the position of the remap
846options on the command line is not significant.
847
848If the @option{verbose} option is enabled then any mappings that match
849will be reported, although again the @option{verbose} option needs to
850be enabled on the command line @emph{before} the remaped filenames
851appear.
852
853If the @option{-Map} or @option{--print-map} options are enabled then
854the remapping list will be included in the map output.
855
252b5132
RH
856@cindex link map
857@kindex -M
858@kindex --print-map
859@item -M
860@itemx --print-map
861Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
862information about the link, including the following:
863
864@itemize @bullet
865@item
3b83e13a 866Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
867@item
868How common symbols are allocated.
869@item
870All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
871which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
872@item
873The values assigned to symbols.
874
875Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
876involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
877have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
878linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
879of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
880the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
881linker script containing:
882
883@smallexample
884 foo = 1
885 foo = foo * 4
886 foo = foo + 8
887@end smallexample
888
889will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
890option is used:
891
892@smallexample
893 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
894 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
895 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
896@end smallexample
897
898See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
899scripts.
d2ef37eb 900
06ddcada
AM
901@item
902How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 903
06ddcada
AM
904When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
905.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
906These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
907
908@smallexample
909Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
910@end smallexample
911
06ddcada 912This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
913merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
914is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
915
916@smallexample
06ddcada 917Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
918@end smallexample
919
06ddcada 920This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
921when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
922is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
923@end itemize
924
035801ce
FS
925@cindex link map discarded
926@kindex --print-map-discarded
927@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
928@item --print-map-discarded
929@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
930Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
931in the link map. Enabled by default.
932
496917ce
NC
933@kindex --print-map-locals
934@kindex --no-print-map-locals
935@item --print-map-locals
936@itemx --no-print-map-locals
937Print (or do not print) local symbols in the link map. Local symbols
938will have the text @samp{(local)} printed before their name, and will
939be listed after all of the global symbols in a given section.
940Temporary local symbols (typically those that start with @samp{.L})
941will not be included in the output. Disabled by default.
942
252b5132
RH
943@kindex -n
944@cindex read-only text
945@cindex NMAGIC
946@kindex --nmagic
947@item -n
948@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
949Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
950libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
951mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
952
953@kindex -N
954@kindex --omagic
955@cindex read/write from cmd line
956@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 957@item -N
252b5132
RH
958@itemx --omagic
959Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
960not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
961libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
962mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
963is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
964specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
965
966@kindex --no-omagic
967@cindex OMAGIC
968@item --no-omagic
969This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
970sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
971be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
972shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
973
974@kindex -o @var{output}
975@kindex --output=@var{output}
976@cindex naming the output file
977@item -o @var{output}
978@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 979Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
980option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
981script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
982
f37b21b4
RM
983@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
984@cindex dependency file
985@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
986Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
987suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
988that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
989output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
990Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
991Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
992to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
993linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
994@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
995installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
996distributed makefiles without careful editing.
997
252b5132
RH
998@kindex -O @var{level}
999@cindex generating optimized output
1000@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 1001If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 1002the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
1003should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
1004option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
1005the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
1006no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
1007of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 1008
387dd777
DP
1009@kindex -plugin @var{name}
1010@item -plugin @var{name}
1011Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
1012the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
1013automatically added by the complier, when using link time
1014optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
1015wish.
1016
1017Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
1018from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
1019@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
1020those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 1021copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 1022based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 1023just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 1024
26278bb8
UD
1025@kindex --push-state
1026@cindex push state governing input file handling
1027@item --push-state
f9a6a8f0 1028The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
26278bb8
UD
1029flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
1030restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
1031
1032The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
1033@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
1034@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
1035@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
1036@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
1037@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
1038
1039One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
1040used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
1041listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
1042something as follows:
1043
1044@smallexample
1045-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
1046@end smallexample
1047
1048@kindex --pop-state
1049@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 1050@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
1051Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
1052flags governing input file handling.
1053
a712da20
NC
1054@kindex -q
1055@kindex --emit-relocs
1056@cindex retain relocations in final executable
1057@item -q
1058@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 1059Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
1060Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
1061order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
1062in larger executables.
1063
dbab7a7b
NC
1064This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
1065
4f471f39
RS
1066@kindex --force-dynamic
1067@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
1068@item --force-dynamic
1069Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
1070to VxWorks targets.
1071
252b5132
RH
1072@cindex partial link
1073@cindex relocatable output
1074@kindex -r
1049f94e 1075@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 1076@item -r
1049f94e 1077@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 1078Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1079turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
1080linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
1081magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
1082@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 1083@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
1084If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
1085linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1086constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1087
62bf86b4
HPN
1088When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1089partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1090relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1091example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1092with input files in other formats at all.
1093
252b5132
RH
1094This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1095
1096@kindex -R @var{file}
1097@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1098@cindex symbol-only input
1099@item -R @var{filename}
1100@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1101Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1102relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1103to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1104programs. You may use this option more than once.
1105
ff5dcc92 1106For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1107followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1108the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1109
1110@kindex -s
1111@kindex --strip-all
1112@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1113@item -s
252b5132
RH
1114@itemx --strip-all
1115Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1116
1117@kindex -S
1118@kindex --strip-debug
1119@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1120@item -S
252b5132
RH
1121@itemx --strip-debug
1122Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1123
a70f34c0
NC
1124@kindex --strip-discarded
1125@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1126@item --strip-discarded
1127@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1128Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1129Enabled by default.
1130
252b5132
RH
1131@kindex -t
1132@kindex --trace
1133@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1134@item -t
252b5132 1135@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1136Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1137@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1138@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1139and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1140a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1141
1142@kindex -T @var{script}
1143@kindex --script=@var{script}
1144@cindex script files
1145@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1146@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1147Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
31f14901
AM
1148@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it),
1149unless the script contains @code{INSERT}, so
252b5132 1150@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1151output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1152the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1153specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1154options accumulate.
252b5132 1155
14be8564
L
1156@kindex -dT @var{script}
1157@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1158@cindex script files
1159@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1160@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1161Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1162
1163This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1164processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1165command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1166@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1167behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1168command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1169the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1170@samp{gcc}).
1171
252b5132
RH
1172@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1173@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1174@cindex undefined symbol
1175@item -u @var{symbol}
1176@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1177Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1178symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1179modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1180different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1181option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1182
0a618243
AB
1183If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1184into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1185undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1186instead.
1187
1188@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1189@cindex symbols, require defined
1190@cindex defined symbol
1191@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1192Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1193is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1194is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1195and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1196@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1197can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1198
252b5132
RH
1199@kindex -Ur
1200@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1201@item -Ur
0a7dda4f
NC
1202
1203For programs that do not use constructors or destructors, or for ELF
1204based systems this option is equivalent to @option{-r}: it generates
1205relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in turn serve as
1206input to @command{ld}. For other binaries however the @option{-Ur}
1207option is similar to @option{-r} but it also resolves references to
1208constructors and destructors.
1209
35f8b059
NC
1210For those systems where @option{-r} and @option{-Ur} behave
1211differently, it does not work to use @option{-Ur} on files that were
1212themselves linked with @option{-Ur}; once the constructor table has
1213been built, it cannot be added to. Use @option{-Ur} only for the last
1214partial link, and @option{-r} for the others.
252b5132 1215
c005eb9e
AB
1216@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1217@cindex orphan sections
1218@cindex sections, orphan
1219@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1220Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1221specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1222
1223@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1224
1225@table @code
1226@item place
1227Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1228the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1229@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1230
1231@item discard
1232All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1233@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1234
1235@item warn
1236The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1237issue a warning.
1238
1239@item error
1240The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1241@end table
1242
1243The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1244
577a0623
AM
1245@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1246@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1247Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1248@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1249missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1250specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1251multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1252input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1253in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1254
252b5132
RH
1255@kindex -v
1256@kindex -V
1257@kindex --version
1258@cindex version
1259@item -v
1260@itemx --version
1261@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1262Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
2d5783fa
NC
1263lists the supported emulations. See also the description of the
1264@option{--enable-linker-version} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}
1265which can be used to insert the linker version string into a binary.
252b5132
RH
1266
1267@kindex -x
1268@kindex --discard-all
1269@cindex deleting local symbols
1270@item -x
1271@itemx --discard-all
1272Delete all local symbols.
1273
1274@kindex -X
1275@kindex --discard-locals
1276@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1277@item -X
252b5132 1278@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1279Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1280system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1281or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1282
1283@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1284@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1285@cindex symbol tracing
1286@item -y @var{symbol}
1287@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1288Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1289option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1290to prepend an underscore.
1291
1292This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1293don't know where the reference is coming from.
1294
1295@kindex -Y @var{path}
1296@item -Y @var{path}
1297Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1298for Solaris compatibility.
1299
1300@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1301@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1302The recognized keywords are:
1303@table @samp
1304
e6e2dfbd
AM
1305@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1306@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1307@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1308@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1309Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1310to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1311@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1312@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1313@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1314@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1315Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1316
233a0083
L
1317@item cet-report=none
1318@itemx cet-report=warning
1319@itemx cet-report=error
1320Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1321GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1322section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1323linker not report missing properties in input files.
1324@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1325missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1326the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1327Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1328GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1329turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1330Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1331
cd6d6c15 1332@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1333@itemx nocombreloc
1334Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1335dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1336
b8871f35 1337@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1338@itemx nocommon
1339Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1340link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1341
1342@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1343Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1344layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1345using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1346
cd6d6c15 1347@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1348Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1349is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1350This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1351
e6e2dfbd
AM
1352@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1353@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1354Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1355if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1356by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1357@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1358may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1359selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1360these options.
1361
6aa29e7b
JJ
1362@item execstack
1363Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1364
b039ef04
L
1365@item global
1366This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1367the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1368of subsequently loaded libraries.
1369
93ab9c0d
NC
1370@item globalaudit
1371This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1372This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1373setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1374tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1375the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1376all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1377
e6e2dfbd
AM
1378@item ibtplt
1379Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1380Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1381
8df93cb5 1382@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1383Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1384to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1385Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1386
6f365fda
L
1387@item indirect-extern-access
1388@itemx noindirect-extern-access
1389Generate GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS in
1390.note.gnu.property section to indicate that object file requires
1391canonical function pointers and cannot be used with copy relocation.
1392This option also implies @option{noextern-protected-data} and
1393@option{nocopyreloc}. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1394
1395@option{noindirect-extern-access} removes
1396GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS from .note.gnu.property
1397section.
1398
cd6d6c15
NC
1399@item initfirst
1400This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1401It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1402before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1403the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1404the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1405objects.
1406
1407@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1408Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1409so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1410libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1411
c3805e4c
VDM
1412@item unique
1413@itemx nounique
1414When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1415object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1416and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1417primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1418al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1419of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1420and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1421
279d901e
L
1422@item lam-u48
1423Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1424to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1425
1426@item lam-u57
1427Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1428to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1429
1430@item lam-u48-report=none
1431@itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1432@itemx lam-u48-report=error
1433Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1434property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1435@option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1436linker not report missing properties in input files.
1437@option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1438missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1439make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1440Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1441
1442@item lam-u57-report=none
1443@itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1444@itemx lam-u57-report=error
1445Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1446property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1447@option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1448linker not report missing properties in input files.
1449@option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1450missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1451make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1452Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1453
1454@item lam-report=none
1455@itemx lam-report=warning
1456@itemx lam-report=error
1457Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1458GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1459section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1460linker not report missing properties in input files.
1461@option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1462missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1463the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1464Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1465
5fa222e4
AM
1466@item lazy
1467When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1468dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1469the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1470Lazy binding is the default.
1471
cd6d6c15 1472@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1473Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1474
e6e2dfbd
AM
1475@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1476Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1477
832ca732
L
1478@item mark-plt
1479@itemx nomark-plt
1480Mark PLT entries with dynamic tags, DT_X86_64_PLT, DT_X86_64_PLTSZ and
1481DT_X86_64_PLTENT. Since this option stores a non-zero value in the
1482r_addend field of R_X86_64_JUMP_SLOT relocations, the resulting
1483executables and shared libraries are incompatible with dynamic linkers,
1484such as those in older versions of glibc without the change to ignore
1485r_addend in R_X86_64_GLOB_DAT and R_X86_64_JUMP_SLOT relocations, which
1486don't ignore the r_addend field of R_X86_64_JUMP_SLOT relocations.
1487Supported for x86_64.
1488
e6e2dfbd
AM
1489@item muldefs
1490Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1491
cd6d6c15 1492@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1493Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1494defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1495
1496@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1497Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1498should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1499
1500@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1501Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1502
1503@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1504Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1505
1506@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1507Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1508
6aa29e7b
JJ
1509@item noexecstack
1510Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1511
e6e2dfbd
AM
1512@item noextern-protected-data
1513Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1514library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1515used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1516generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1517module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1518i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1519
e6e2dfbd
AM
1520@item noreloc-overflow
1521Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1522relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1523overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1524
cd6d6c15
NC
1525@item now
1526When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1527dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1528when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1529function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1530called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1531
1532@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1533Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1534
6a91be86
L
1535@item pack-relative-relocs
1536@itemx nopack-relative-relocs
1537Generate compact relative relocation in position-independent executable
1538and shared library. It adds @code{DT_RELR}, @code{DT_RELRSZ} and
1539@code{DT_RELRENT} entries to the dynamic section. It is ignored when
1540building position-dependent executable and relocatable output.
1541@option{nopack-relative-relocs} is the default, which disables compact
72aa8173
L
1542relative relocation. When linked against the GNU C Library, a
1543GLIBC_ABI_DT_RELR symbol version dependency on the shared C Library is
1544added to the output. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
6a91be86 1545
6aa29e7b 1546@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1547@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1548Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1549specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1550relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1551than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1552Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1553
68b00778
L
1554@item report-relative-reloc
1555Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1556Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1557
96cc7918
KB
1558@item sectionheader
1559@itemx nosectionheader
1560Generate section header. Don't generate section header if
1561@samp{nosectionheader} is used. @option{sectionheader} is the default.
1562
47acac12
L
1563@item separate-code
1564@itemx noseparate-code
1565Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1566specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1567be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1568code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1569
e6e2dfbd
AM
1570@item shstk
1571Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1572to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1573Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1574
04c3a755 1575@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1576Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1577Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1578@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1579
8ee10e86
AM
1580@item start-stop-gc
1581@itemx nostart-stop-gc
1582@cindex start-stop-gc
1583When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1584section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1585input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1586@code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1587@code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1588linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1589sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1590were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1591definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1592object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1593linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1594@code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1595treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1596
cae64165
RM
1597@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1598@cindex visibility
1599@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1600Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1601@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1602Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1603@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1604start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1605compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1606recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1607programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1608between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1609
e6e2dfbd
AM
1610@item text
1611@itemx notext
1612@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1613Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1614or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1615report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1616
97a232d7
NC
1617@item undefs
1618Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1619either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1620This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1621
2d95647b
L
1622@item unique-symbol
1623@itemx nounique-symbol
1624Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1625".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1626is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1627
b0ab0693 1628@item x86-64-baseline
32930e4e
L
1629@item x86-64-v2
1630@item x86-64-v3
1631@itemx x86-64-v4
1632Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
b0ab0693 1633@option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
32930e4e
L
1634@option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1635@option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1636@option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1637Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1638
cd6d6c15
NC
1639@end table
1640
ece2d90e 1641Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1642
1643@kindex -(
1644@cindex groups of archives
1645@item -( @var{archives} -)
1646@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1647The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1648either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1649
1650The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1651references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1652the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1653archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1654object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1655would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1656they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1657resolved.
1658
1659Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1660it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1661more archives.
1662
69da35b5
NC
1663@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1664@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1665@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1666@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1667Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1668recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1669and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1670the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1671behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1672so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1673restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1674
4a43e768
AM
1675@kindex --as-needed
1676@kindex --no-as-needed
1677@item --as-needed
1678@itemx --no-as-needed
1679This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1680on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1681the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1682on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1683needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1684emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1685non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1686the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1687non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1688Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1689the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1690needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1691from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1692
6418520e
NC
1693Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1694an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1695@option{--rpath-link} options. See the description of
1696@option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1697
e56f61be
L
1698@kindex --add-needed
1699@kindex --no-add-needed
1700@item --add-needed
1701@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1702These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1703their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1704options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1705and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1706
252b5132
RH
1707@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1708@item -assert @var{keyword}
1709This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1710
1711@kindex -Bdynamic
1712@kindex -dy
1713@kindex -call_shared
1714@item -Bdynamic
1715@itemx -dy
1716@itemx -call_shared
1717Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1718for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1719default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1720for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1721multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1722@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1723
a1ab1d2a
UD
1724@kindex -Bgroup
1725@item -Bgroup
1726Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1727section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1728object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1729@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1730only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1731
252b5132
RH
1732@kindex -Bstatic
1733@kindex -dn
1734@kindex -non_shared
1735@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1736@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1737@itemx -dn
1738@itemx -non_shared
1739@itemx -static
1740Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1741platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1742variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1743may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1744library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1745option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1746option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1747shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1748references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1749libraries.
252b5132
RH
1750
1751@kindex -Bsymbolic
1752@item -Bsymbolic
1753When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1754definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1755for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1756within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1757platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1758
40b36307
L
1759@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1760@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1761When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1762symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1763This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1764libraries.
40b36307 1765
cf893b0e
FS
1766@kindex -Bno-symbolic
1767@item -Bno-symbolic
1768This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and
1769@samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}.
1770
55255dae
L
1771@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1772@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1773Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1774typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1775global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1776within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1777to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1778in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1779which support shared libraries.
1780
1781The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1782scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1783
40b36307
L
1784@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1785@item --dynamic-list-data
1786Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1787
1788@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1789@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1790Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1791is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1792
0b8a70d9
L
1793@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1794@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1795Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1796
252b5132
RH
1797@kindex --check-sections
1798@kindex --no-check-sections
1799@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1800@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1801Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1802been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1803perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1804suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1805allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1806restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1807Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1808force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1809option.
252b5132 1810
ddbb8a31
NC
1811@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1812@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1813@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1814@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1815This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1816by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1817command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1818output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1819input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1820specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1821follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1822behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1823
1824This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1825libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1826mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1827their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1828required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1829the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1830dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1831symbols.
1832
252b5132
RH
1833@cindex cross reference table
1834@kindex --cref
1835@item --cref
1836Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1837generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1838Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1839
1840The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1841easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1842sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1843symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1844definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1845where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1846symbol are listed.
252b5132 1847
5dba6f05
NA
1848@cindex ctf variables
1849@kindex --ctf-variables
1850@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1851@item --ctf-variables
1852@item --no-ctf-variables
1853The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1854types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1855table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1856conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1857usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1858@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1859The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1860
1861@cindex ctf type sharing
1862@kindex --ctf-share-types
1863@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1864Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1865
1866@table @samp
1867@item share-unconflicted
1868Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1869where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1870translation unit. This is the default.
1871
1872@item share-duplicated
1873Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1874dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1875dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1876always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1877larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1878large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1879consumer at runtime.
1880@end table
1881
4818e05f
AM
1882@cindex common allocation
1883@kindex --no-define-common
1884@item --no-define-common
1885This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1886The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1887@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1888
1889The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1890the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1891of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1892forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1893Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1894from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1895This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1896and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1897duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1898paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1899
7bdf4127
AB
1900@cindex group allocation in linker script
1901@cindex section groups
1902@cindex COMDAT
1903@kindex --force-group-allocation
1904@item --force-group-allocation
1905This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1906normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1907default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1908change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1909command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1910effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1911
252b5132 1912@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1913@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1914@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1915Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1916address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1917times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1918limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1919context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1920symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1921constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1922using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1923@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1924equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132 1925
54874444
AB
1926The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1927in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1928symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1929placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1930the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1931consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1932@samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1933you are trying to achieve.
1934
252b5132 1935@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1936@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1937@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1938@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1939@itemx --no-demangle
1940These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1941and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1942present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1943underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1944mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1945different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1946to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1947demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1948is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1949
1950@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1951@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1952@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1953@item -I@var{file}
1954@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1955Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1956generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1957linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1958doing.
1959
9b8b325a
RF
1960@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1961@item --no-dynamic-linker
1962When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1963linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1964executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1965entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1966
a70f34c0
NC
1967@kindex --embedded-relocs
1968@item --embedded-relocs
1969This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1970that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1971is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1972targets.
1973
3f0a5f17
ME
1974@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1975@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1976Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1977in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1978
7ce691ae 1979@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1980@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1981@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1982@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1983Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1984with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1985
4b2e7a57
NC
1986@kindex -w
1987@kindex --no-warnings
1988@item -w
1989@itemx --no-warnings
1990Do not display any warning or error messages. This overrides
1991@option{--fatal-warnings} if it has been enabled. This option can be
1992used when it is known that the output binary will not work, but there
1993is still a need to create it.
1994
252b5132
RH
1995@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1996@item --force-exe-suffix
1997Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1998
1999If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
2000@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
2001the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
2002option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
2003Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
2004it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
2005
2006@kindex --gc-sections
2007@kindex --no-gc-sections
2008@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
2009@item --gc-sections
2010@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 2011Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 2012targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 2013performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
2014@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
2015collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
2016implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 2017
d5465ba2
AM
2018@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
2019examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
2020symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
2021command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
2022referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
2023libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
2024referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
2025the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
2026relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
2027@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 2028
ac69cbc6 2029This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 2030@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
2031specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
2032@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
2033command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 2034
99fabbc9
JL
2035As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
2036@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
2037
c17d87de
NC
2038@kindex --print-gc-sections
2039@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
2040@cindex garbage collection
2041@item --print-gc-sections
2042@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
2043List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
2044printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
2045collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
2046default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
2047be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
2048line.
2049
22185505 2050@kindex --gc-keep-exported
2051@cindex garbage collection
2052@item --gc-keep-exported
2053When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
2054collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
2055default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
2056executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
2057collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
2058Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
2059it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
2060ELF format targets.
2061
30824704
RM
2062@kindex --print-output-format
2063@cindex output format
2064@item --print-output-format
2065Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
2066other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
2067in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
2068
3604cb1f
TG
2069@kindex --print-memory-usage
2070@cindex memory usage
2071@item --print-memory-usage
2072Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
2073the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
2074quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
2075headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
2076parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
2077
2078@smallexample
2079Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
2080 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
2081 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
2082@end smallexample
2083
252b5132
RH
2084@cindex help
2085@cindex usage
2086@kindex --help
2087@item --help
2088Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
2089
ea20a7da
CC
2090@kindex --target-help
2091@item --target-help
a094d01f 2092Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 2093
2509a395
SL
2094@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
2095@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 2096Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
2c72361c
NC
2097@option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
2098@code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
2099
2100Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
2101written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
2102inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
2103file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
2104@code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
2105output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
2106@var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
2107
2108@smallexample
2109 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
2110 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
2111 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2112 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2113 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
2114 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2115 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
2116 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
2117 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
2118 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
2119@end smallexample
2120
2121It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
2122
2123If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
2124operation.
252b5132
RH
2125
2126@cindex memory usage
2127@kindex --no-keep-memory
2128@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
2129@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
2130symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 2131instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 2132necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
2133while linking a large executable.
2134
2135@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 2136@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 2137@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 2138@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 2139@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
2140Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
2141is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
2142The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
2143behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 2144libraries being linked in.
252b5132 2145
97a232d7
NC
2146The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2147
aa713662
L
2148@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2149@kindex -z muldefs
2150@item --allow-multiple-definition
2151@itemx -z muldefs
2152Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2153report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2154first definition will be used.
2155
b79e8c78 2156@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2157@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 2158@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2159@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 2160Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
2161This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2162determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2163shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2164how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2165
903249d7
NC
2166The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2167referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2168an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2169a shared library.
2170
2171The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2172libraries specified at link time are that:
2173
2174@itemize @bullet
2175@item
2176A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2177that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2178resolvable at load time.
2179@item
2180There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2181symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2182
2183The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2184select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2185architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2186appropriate memset function.
2187@end itemize
b79e8c78 2188
23ae20f5
NC
2189@kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2190@item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2191If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2192@var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2193only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2194libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
5c14cc55 2195``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
93cf38c0
NC
2196undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2197will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
23ae20f5
NC
2198might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2199error message will be displayed.
2200
2201The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2202switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2203
31941635
L
2204@kindex --no-undefined-version
2205@item --no-undefined-version
2206Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2207it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2208will be issued instead.
2209
3e3b46e5
PB
2210@kindex --default-symver
2211@item --default-symver
2212Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
2213exported symbols.
2214
2215@kindex --default-imported-symver
2216@item --default-imported-symver
2217Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2218imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 2219
252b5132
RH
2220@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2221@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 2222Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
2223files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2224been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 2225This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
2226errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2227have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2228inappropriate.
2229
fe7929ce
AM
2230@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2231@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2232Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2233library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2234
252b5132
RH
2235@kindex --no-whole-archive
2236@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 2237Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
2238archive files.
2239
2240@cindex output file after errors
2241@kindex --noinhibit-exec
2242@item --noinhibit-exec
2243Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2244Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2245errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2246when it issues any error whatsoever.
2247
0a9c1c8e
CD
2248@kindex -nostdlib
2249@item -nostdlib
2250Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2251command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2252(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2253
252b5132 2254@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
2255@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2256@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
2257@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2258file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 2259@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
2260object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2261object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
2262should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2263usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2264name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2265list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2266command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2267this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2268@end ifclear
2269
76359541
TP
2270@kindex --out-implib
2271@item --out-implib @var{file}
2272Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2273the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2274library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2275may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2276behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2277step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2278the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2279
36af4a4e
JJ
2280@kindex -pie
2281@kindex --pic-executable
2282@item -pie
2283@itemx --pic-executable
2284@cindex position independent executables
2285Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2286ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2287libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 2288address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
2289normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2290defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2291
e8f6c2a5
FS
2292@kindex -no-pie
2293@item -no-pie
2294@cindex position dependent executables
2295Create a position dependent executable. This is the default.
2296
252b5132
RH
2297@kindex -qmagic
2298@item -qmagic
2299This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2300
2301@kindex -Qy
2302@item -Qy
2303This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2304
2305@kindex --relax
2306@cindex synthesizing linker
2307@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 2308@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 2309@item --relax
28d5f677 2310@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 2311An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
2312@ifset GENERIC
2313This option is only supported on a few targets.
2314@end ifset
2315@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 2316@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 2317@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
2318@ifset XTENSA
2319@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2320@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
2321@ifset M68HC11
2322@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2323@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
2324@ifset NIOSII
2325@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2326@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
2327@ifset POWERPC
2328@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2329@end ifset
252b5132 2330
ccd9fae5 2331On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
28d5f677
NC
2332global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2333addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2334synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2335instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2336
2337On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2338debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2339@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2340This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2341family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2342@end ifset
2343
ccd9fae5
NC
2344On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2345@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
28d5f677 2346
ccd9fae5
NC
2347On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2348and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
5c14cc55 2349
252b5132
RH
2350@cindex retaining specified symbols
2351@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2352@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2353@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2354@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2355Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2356discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2357symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2358@ifset GENERIC
2359(such as VxWorks)
2360@end ifset
2361where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2362run-time memory.
2363
2364@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2365or symbols needed for relocations.
2366
2367You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2368line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2369
2370@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2371@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2372@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2373@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2374Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2375linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2376arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2377them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2378
2379The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2380are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2381description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2382in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2383have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2384
2385If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2386contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2387is defined.
252b5132 2388
ff5dcc92 2389The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2390SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2391@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2392runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2393options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2394gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2395file systems.
252b5132 2396
ff5dcc92 2397For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2398followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2399the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2400@end ifset
2401
2402@ifset GENERIC
2403@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2404@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2405@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2406When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2407happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2408of the input files.
2409
2410When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2411non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2412shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2413explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2414specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2415@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2416either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2417appearing multiple times.
2418
e680a6b6
NC
2419The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2420directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2421containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2422and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
242364-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2424
2425The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2426@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2427supported.
2428
28c309a2
NC
2429This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2430that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2431is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2432runtime linker would do.
2433
252b5132 2434The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2435libraries:
d8e4137b 2436
252b5132
RH
2437@enumerate
2438@item
ff5dcc92 2439Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2440@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2441Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2442between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2443specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2444used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2445at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2446by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2447the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2448@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2449On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2450@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2451environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2452@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2453On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2454directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2455@item
a1b8d843 2456For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2457variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2458@item
ec4eb78a
L
2459For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2460@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2461libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2462@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2463@item
d8e4137b
NC
2464For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2465exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2466to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2467defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2468configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2469@item
2470For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2471the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2472header file.
2473@item
364d7729
AM
2474Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a
2475linker script given on the command line, including scripts specified
2476by @option{-T} (but not @option{-dT}).
2477@item
2478The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2479@item
2480Any directories specified by a plugin LDPT_SET_EXTRA_LIBRARY_PATH.
2481@item
2482Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a default
2483linker script.
252b5132
RH
2484@end enumerate
2485
6418520e
NC
2486Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat: If
2487the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2488is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2489library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2490@emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2491directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2492this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2493@file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2494of the first.
2495
252b5132
RH
2496If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2497warning and continue with the link.
6418520e 2498
252b5132
RH
2499@end ifset
2500
2501@kindex -shared
2502@kindex -Bshareable
2503@item -shared
2504@itemx -Bshareable
2505@cindex shared libraries
2506Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2507and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2508shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2509undefined symbols in the link.
2510
252b5132 2511@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2512@item --sort-common
2513@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2514@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2515This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2516ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2517sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2518eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2519between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2520specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2521
2509a395
SL
2522@kindex --sort-section=name
2523@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2524This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2525patterns in the linker script.
2526
2509a395
SL
2527@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2528@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2529This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2530patterns in the linker script.
2531
a70f34c0
NC
2532@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2533@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2534This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2535.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2536post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2537
252b5132 2538@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2539@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2540Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2541each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2542size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2543
2544@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2545@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2546Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2547output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2548This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2549certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2550cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2551that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2552support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2553input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2554more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2555many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2556
2557@kindex --stats
2558@item --stats
2559Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2560as execution time and memory usage.
2561
2509a395 2562@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2563@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2564Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2565configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2566that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2567
a70f34c0
NC
2568@kindex --task-link
2569@item --task-link
2570This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2571file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2572
252b5132
RH
2573@kindex --traditional-format
2574@cindex traditional format
2575@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2576For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2577the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2578use the traditional format instead.
2579
2580@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2581For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2582symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2583full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2584@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2585trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2586combine duplicate entries.
2587
2509a395
SL
2588@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2589@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2590Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2591address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2592times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2593line.
2594@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2595for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2596@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2597should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2598sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2599
2509a395
SL
2600@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2601@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2602@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2603@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2604@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2605@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2606@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2607Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2608@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2609
2509a395
SL
2610@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2611@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2612@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2613When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2614byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2615
9d5777a3
RM
2616@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2617@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2618@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2619When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2620the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2621text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2622
0d705e9f
AM
2623@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2624@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2625@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2626When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2627model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2628
560e09e9
NC
2629@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2630@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2631Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2632values for @samp{method}:
2633
2634@table @samp
2635@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2636Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2637
2638@item report-all
da8bce14 2639Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2640
2641@item ignore-in-object-files
2642Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2643ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2644
2645@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2646Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2647ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2648when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2649libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2650command line.
2651@end table
2652
2653The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2654by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2655
2656Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2657unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2658can change this to a warning.
2659
1715a13c
L
2660@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2661@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2662@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2663@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2664Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2665supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2666the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2667argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2668
2669@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2670@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2671@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2672Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2673used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2674about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2675is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2676see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2677use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2678symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2679@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2680
7ce691ae 2681@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2682@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2683@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2684@item --warn-common
2685Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2686a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2687but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2688you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2689Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2690warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2691
2692There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2693
2694@table @samp
2695@item int i = 1;
2696A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2697file.
2698
2699@item extern int i;
2700An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2701There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2702variable somewhere.
2703
2704@item int i;
2705A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2706variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2707The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2708single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2709size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2710a definition of the same variable.
2711@end table
2712
2713The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2714Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2715just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2716encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2717a common symbol.
2718
2719@enumerate
2720@item
2721Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2722definition for the symbol.
2723@smallexample
2724@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2725 overridden by definition
2726@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2727@end smallexample
2728
2729@item
2730Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2731the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2732except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2733@smallexample
2734@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2735 overriding common
2736@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2737@end smallexample
2738
2739@item
2740Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2741@smallexample
2742@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2743 of `@var{symbol}'
2744@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2745@end smallexample
2746
2747@item
2748Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2749@smallexample
2750@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2751 overridden by larger common
2752@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2753@end smallexample
2754
2755@item
2756Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2757the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2758encountered in a different order.
2759@smallexample
2760@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2761 overriding smaller common
2762@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2763@end smallexample
2764@end enumerate
2765
2766@kindex --warn-constructors
2767@item --warn-constructors
2768Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2769object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2770detect the use of global constructors.
2771
65daf5be 2772@kindex --warn-execstack
bd7d326d 2773@cindex warnings, on executable stack
65daf5be
NC
2774@cindex executable stack, warnings on
2775@item --warn-execstack
2776@itemx --no-warn-execstack
2777On ELF platforms this option controls how the linker generates warning
2778messages when it creates an output file with an executable stack. By
2779default the linker will not warn if the @command{-z execstack} command
2780line option has been used, but this behaviour can be overridden by the
2781@option{--warn-execstack} option.
2782
2783On the other hand the linker will normally warn if the stack is made
2784executable because one or more of the input files need an execuable
2785stack and neither of the @command{-z execstack} or @command{-z
bd7d326d 2786noexecstack} command line options have been specified. This warning
65daf5be
NC
2787can be disabled via the @command{--no-warn-execstack} option.
2788
2789Note: ELF format input files specify that they need an executable
2790stack by having a @var{.note.GNU-stack} section with the executable
2791bit set in its section flags. They can specify that they do not need
2792an executable stack by having that section, but without the executable
2793flag bit set. If an input file does not have a @var{.note.GNU-stack}
2794section present then the default behaviour is target specific. For
2795some targets, then absence of such a section implies that an
2796executable stack @emph{is} required. This is often a problem for hand
2797crafted assembler files.
2798
252b5132
RH
2799@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2800@item --warn-multiple-gp
2801Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2802This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2803Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2804section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2805of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2806base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2807base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2808bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2809large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2810values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2811option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2812
2813@kindex --warn-once
2814@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2815@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2816@item --warn-once
2817Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2818which refers to it.
2819
ba951afb
NC
2820@kindex --warn-rwx-segments
2821@cindex warnings, on writeable and exectuable segments
2822@cindex executable segments, warnings on
2823@item --warn-rwx-segments
2824@itemx --no-warn-rwx-segments
2825Warn if the linker creates a loadable, non-zero sized segment that has
2826all three of the read, write and execute permission flags set. Such a
2827segment represents a potential security vulnerability. In addition
2828warnings will be generated if a thread local storage segment is
2829created with the execute permission flag set, regardless of whether or
2830not it has the read and/or write flags set.
2831
2832These warnings are enabled by default. They can be disabled via the
2833@option{--no-warn-rwx-segments} option and re-enabled via the
2834@option{--warn-rwx-segments} option.
2835
252b5132
RH
2836@kindex --warn-section-align
2837@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2838@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2839@item --warn-section-align
2840Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2841alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2842The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2843is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2844the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2845
a6dbf402
L
2846@kindex --warn-textrel
2847@item --warn-textrel
2848Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2849or shared object.
8fdd7217 2850
a0c402a5
L
2851@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2852@item --warn-alternate-em
2853Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2854
560e09e9
NC
2855@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2856@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2857If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2858@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2859This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2860
2861@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2862@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2863This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2864it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2865
252b5132
RH
2866@kindex --whole-archive
2867@cindex including an entire archive
2868@item --whole-archive
2869For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2870@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2871in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2872files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2873library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2874library. This option may be used more than once.
2875
7ec229ce 2876Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2877about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2878Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2879list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2880your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2881
2509a395
SL
2882@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2883@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2884Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2885@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2886undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2887@var{symbol}.
2888
2889This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2890wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2891wishes to call the system function, it should call
2892@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2893
2894Here is a trivial example:
2895
2896@smallexample
2897void *
cc2f008e 2898__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2899@{
cc2f008e 2900 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2901 return __real_malloc (c);
2902@}
2903@end smallexample
2904
ff5dcc92 2905If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2906all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2907instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2908call the real @code{malloc} function.
2909
2910You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2911links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2912you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2913file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2914call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2915
4ea904ed
SH
2916Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2917internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2918@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2919@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2920
2921@smallexample
2922int
2923f (void)
2924@{
2925 return 123;
2926@}
2927
2928int
2929g (void)
2930@{
2931 return f();
2932@}
2933@end smallexample
2934
6aa29e7b 2935@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2936@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2937@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2938@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2939Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2940(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2941section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2942
e41b3a13
JJ
2943@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2944@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2945Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2946generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
cf0e0a0b 2947if linker generated unwind info is supported. This option also
1bd123bd 2948controls the generation of @code{.sframe} stack trace info for linker
cf0e0a0b 2949generated code sections like PLT.
e41b3a13 2950
6c1439be
L
2951@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2952@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2953@item --enable-new-dtags
2954@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2955This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2956systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2957@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2958and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2959If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2960created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2961those options are only available for ELF systems.
2962
2d643429 2963@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2964@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2965Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2966close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2967time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2968increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2969value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2970
fdc90cb4
JJ
2971@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2972@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2973Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2974@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2975new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2976the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2977hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2978but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2979
0ce398f1
L
2980@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2981@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2982@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2983@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2cac01e3 2984@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zstd
0ce398f1
L
2985@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2986@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2987@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2988@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2cac01e3 2989@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zstd
9af89fba
NC
2990On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2991compressed using zlib.
2992
2993@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2994sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2995DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2996instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2997also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2998sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2999
3000The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
3001@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
3002
2cac01e3
FS
3003@option{--compress-debug-sections=zstd} compresses DWARF debug sections using
3004zstd.
3005
9af89fba
NC
3006Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
3007sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
3008for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
3009uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
3010
3011The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
3012involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
3013default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
3014@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 3015
35835446
JR
3016@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
3017@item --reduce-memory-overheads
3018This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 3019linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 3020for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
3021about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
3022
4f9c04f7 3023Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 30241021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 3025run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
3026has been used.
3027
3028The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
3029enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 3030
a8dde0a2
L
3031@kindex --max-cache-size=@var{size}
3032@item --max-cache-size=@var{size}
3033@command{ld} normally caches the relocation information and symbol tables
3034of input files in memory with the unlimited size. This option sets the
3035maximum cache size to @var{size}.
3036
c0065db7
RM
3037@kindex --build-id
3038@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
3039@item --build-id
3040@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 3041Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 3042or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
3043unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
3044@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
3045@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
3046@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
3047the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
3048string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
3049@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
3050is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
3051
3052The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
3053that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
3054unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
3055to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
3056file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
3057string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
3058
3059Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
3060@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
9e2bb0cb
LB
3061
3062@kindex --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
3063@item --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
3064Request the creation of a @code{.note.package} ELF note section. The
3065contents of the note are in JSON format, as per the package metadata
3066specification. For more information see:
3067https://systemd.io/ELF_PACKAGE_METADATA/
3068If the JSON argument is missing/empty then this will disable the
3069creation of the metadata note, if one had been enabled by an earlier
8fa1b632 3070occurrence of the --package-metadata option.
9e2bb0cb
LB
3071If the linker has been built with libjansson, then the JSON string
3072will be validated.
252b5132
RH
3073@end table
3074
0285c67d
NC
3075@c man end
3076
36f63dca 3077@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 3078
0285c67d
NC
3079@c man begin OPTIONS
3080
ff5dcc92 3081The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
3082the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
3083normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
3084use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
3085@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
3086like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
3087symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
3088object file).
3089
3090In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 3091support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
3092PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
3093values by either a space or an equals sign.
3094
ff5dcc92 3095@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
3096
3097@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
3098@item --add-stdcall-alias
3099If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
3100as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 3101[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3102
3103@kindex --base-file
3104@item --base-file @var{file}
3105Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
3106addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
3107@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 3108[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
3109
3110@kindex --dll
3111@item --dll
3112Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 3113@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 3114file.
bb10df36 3115[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3116
88183869
DK
3117@kindex --enable-long-section-names
3118@kindex --disable-long-section-names
3119@item --enable-long-section-names
3120@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 3121The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 3122the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
3123for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
3124fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
3125to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
3126allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
3127disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
3128generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
3129as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
3130with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
3131GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
3132information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
3133option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
3134section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
3135when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
3136image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
3137[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
3138
252b5132
RH
3139@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
3140@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
3141@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
3142@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
3143If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 3144do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
3145only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
3146resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
3147undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
3148@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
3149to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
3150warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
3151import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 3152to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 3153feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 3154@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 3155mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 3156[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3157
522f09cd
KT
3158@kindex --leading-underscore
3159@kindex --no-leading-underscore
3160@item --leading-underscore
3161@itemx --no-leading-underscore
3162For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
3163in target's description. By this option it is possible to
3164disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
3165
252b5132
RH
3166@cindex DLLs, creating
3167@kindex --export-all-symbols
3168@item --export-all-symbols
3169If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
3170be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
3171otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
3172explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
3173attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
3174option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 3175@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 3176@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
3177exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
3178re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
3179such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
3180@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
3181@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
3182Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
3183not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 3184extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 3185(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 3186These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 3187@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 3188@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 3189@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 3190@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 3191[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3192
3193@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 3194@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
3195Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
3196exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 3197[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3198
2927aaca
NC
3199@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
3200@item --exclude-all-symbols
3201Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
3202[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3203
252b5132
RH
3204@kindex --file-alignment
3205@item --file-alignment
3206Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
3207file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
3208512.
bb10df36 3209[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3210
3211@cindex heap size
3212@kindex --heap
3213@item --heap @var{reserve}
3214@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3215Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3216to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3217committed.
bb10df36 3218[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3219
3220@cindex image base
3221@kindex --image-base
3222@item --image-base @var{value}
3223Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
3224the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3225is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3226your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3227other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3228for dlls.
bb10df36 3229[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3230
3231@kindex --kill-at
3232@item --kill-at
3233If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3234symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 3235[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3236
26d2d8a2
BF
3237@kindex --large-address-aware
3238@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 3239If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 3240header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 3241greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
3242or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3243section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3244[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3245
f69a2f97
NC
3246@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3247@item --disable-large-address-aware
3248Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3249This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3250driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3251addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3252[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3253
252b5132
RH
3254@kindex --major-image-version
3255@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3256Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 3257[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3258
3259@kindex --major-os-version
3260@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3261Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3262[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3263
3264@kindex --major-subsystem-version
3265@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3266Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3267[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3268
3269@kindex --minor-image-version
3270@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3271Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3272[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3273
3274@kindex --minor-os-version
3275@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3276Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3277[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3278
3279@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3280@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3281Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3282[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3283
3284@cindex DEF files, creating
3285@cindex DLLs, creating
3286@kindex --output-def
3287@item --output-def @var{file}
3288The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3289file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3290(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3291library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3292automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 3293[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3294
b044cda1 3295@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
3296@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3297@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
3298@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3299Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3300@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3301By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3302for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3303execution are avoided.
bb10df36 3304[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3305
3306@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3307@item --disable-auto-image-base
3308Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3309user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3310default.
bb10df36 3311[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3312
3313@cindex DLLs, linking to
3314@kindex --dll-search-prefix
3315@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 3316When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 3317search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 3318@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
3319between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3320uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 3321@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 3322[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3323
3324@kindex --enable-auto-import
3325@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 3326Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
3327DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3328mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3329[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3330
3331The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3332feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3333
3334Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3335of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3336PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 3337
e2a83dd0
NC
3338Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3339data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3340placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3341around a problem with consts that is described here:
3342http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3343
4d8907ac
DS
3344Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3345see this message:
0d888aac 3346
ece2d90e 3347"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
3348documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3349
ece2d90e
NC
3350This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3351ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
3352allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3353fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3354constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
3355multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3356this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3357of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3358the warning, and exit.
3359
3360There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3361data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 3362
2fa9fc65
NC
3363One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3364of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 3365this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 3366
c0065db7
RM
3367A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3368that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3369there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
3370a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3371
3372@example
3373extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3374extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3375 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3376@end example
3377
3378or
3379
3380@example
3381extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3382extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3383 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3384@end example
3385
c0065db7 3386For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 3387is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
3388
3389@example
3390extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 3391extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
3392 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3393@end example
3394
c406afaf
NC
3395or
3396
3397@example
3398extern long long extern_ll;
3399extern_ll -->
3400 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3401@end example
3402
2fa9fc65 3403A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 3404'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 3405@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 3406requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
3407building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3408merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3409between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
3410constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3411
3412Original:
3413@example
3414--foo.h
3415extern int arr[];
3416--foo.c
3417#include "foo.h"
3418void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3419 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3420@}
3421@end example
3422
3423Solution 1:
3424@example
3425--foo.h
3426extern int arr[];
3427--foo.c
3428#include "foo.h"
3429void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3430 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3431 volatile int *parr = arr;
3432 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3433@}
3434@end example
3435
3436Solution 2:
3437@example
3438--foo.h
3439/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3440#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3441 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3442#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3443#else
3444#define FOO_IMPORT
3445#endif
3446extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3447--foo.c
3448#include "foo.h"
3449void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3450 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3451@}
3452@end example
3453
c0065db7 3454A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3455library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3456for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3457functions).
b044cda1
CW
3458
3459@kindex --disable-auto-import
3460@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3461Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3462@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3463[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3464
2fa9fc65
NC
3465@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3466@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3467If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3468that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3469a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3470environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3471[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3472
3473@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3474@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3475Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3476[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3477
b044cda1
CW
3478@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3479@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3480Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3481[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3482
252b5132
RH
3483@kindex --section-alignment
3484@item --section-alignment
3485Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3486addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3487[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3488
3489@cindex stack size
3490@kindex --stack
3491@item --stack @var{reserve}
3492@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3493Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3494to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3495committed.
bb10df36 3496[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3497
3498@kindex --subsystem
3499@item --subsystem @var{which}
3500@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3501@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3502Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3503legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3504@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3505the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3506@var{which}.
bb10df36 3507[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3508
2f563b51
DK
3509The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3510of the PE file header:
3511[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3512
2d5c3743
NC
3513@kindex --high-entropy-va
3514@item --high-entropy-va
514b4e19 3515@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
2d5c3743 3516Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
514b4e19
JD
3517(ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3518
dc9bd8c9
HD
3519This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3520@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3521
2f563b51
DK
3522@kindex --dynamicbase
3523@item --dynamicbase
514b4e19 3524@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
2f563b51
DK
3525The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3526randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
514b4e19
JD
3527Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3528can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
dc9bd8c9 3529This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3530
3531@kindex --forceinteg
3532@item --forceinteg
514b4e19
JD
3533@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3534Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3535default.
2f563b51
DK
3536
3537@kindex --nxcompat
3538@item --nxcompat
514b4e19 3539@item --disable-nxcompat
2f563b51 3540The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
514b4e19
JD
3541This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3542targets. The option is enabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3543
3544@kindex --no-isolation
3545@item --no-isolation
514b4e19 3546@itemx --disable-no-isolation
2f563b51 3547Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
514b4e19 3548This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3549
3550@kindex --no-seh
3551@item --no-seh
514b4e19 3552@itemx --disable-no-seh
2f563b51 3553The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
514b4e19 3554this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3555
3556@kindex --no-bind
3557@item --no-bind
514b4e19
JD
3558@itemx --disable-no-bind
3559Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3560
3561@kindex --wdmdriver
3562@item --wdmdriver
514b4e19
JD
3563@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3564The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3565by default.
9d5777a3 3566
2f563b51
DK
3567@kindex --tsaware
3568@item --tsaware
514b4e19
JD
3569@itemx --disable-tsaware
3570The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3571default.
2f563b51 3572
0cb112f7
CF
3573@kindex --insert-timestamp
3574@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3575@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3576Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3577as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3578other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3579will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3580same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3581can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3582that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3583identically.
dc9bd8c9 3584
b5c37946
SJ
3585If @option{--insert-timestamp} is active then the time inserted is
3586either the time that the linking takes place or, if the
3587@code{SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH} environment variable is defined, the number
3588of seconds since Unix epoch as specified by that variable.
3589
dc9bd8c9
HD
3590@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3591@item --enable-reloc-section
514b4e19 3592@itemx --disable-reloc-section
dc9bd8c9
HD
3593Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3594is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
514b4e19 3595This option is enabled by default.
252b5132
RH
3596@end table
3597
0285c67d
NC
3598@c man end
3599
ac145307
BS
3600@ifset C6X
3601@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3602
3603@c man begin OPTIONS
3604
3605The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3606libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3607all executables use an index of 0.
3608
3609@table @gcctabopt
3610
3611@kindex --dsbt-size
3612@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3613This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3614or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3615entries.
3616
3617@kindex --dsbt-index
3618@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3619This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3620to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3621executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3622@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3623
fbd9ad90
PB
3624@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3625The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3626exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3627
ac145307
BS
3628@end table
3629
3630@c man end
3631@end ifset
3632
b8891f8d
AJ
3633@ifset CSKY
3634@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3635
3636@c man begin OPTIONS
3637
3638@table @gcctabopt
3639
3640@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3641@item --branch-stub
3642This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3643sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3644usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3645can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3646the compiler or assembler.
3647
3648@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3649@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3650This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3651It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3652be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3653stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3654sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3655@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3656linker should choose suitable defaults.
3657
3658@end table
3659
3660@c man end
3661@end ifset
3662
93fd0973
SC
3663@ifset M68HC11
3664@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3665
3666@c man begin OPTIONS
3667
3668The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3669memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3670
3671@table @gcctabopt
3672
3673@kindex --no-trampoline
3674@item --no-trampoline
3675This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3676is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3677instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3678
3679@kindex --bank-window
3680@item --bank-window @var{name}
3681This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3682the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3683The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3684paging and addresses within the memory window.
3685
3686@end table
3687
3688@c man end
3689@end ifset
3690
7fb9f789
NC
3691@ifset M68K
3692@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3693
3694@c man begin OPTIONS
3695
3696The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3697when linking for 68K targets.
3698
3699@table @gcctabopt
3700
3701@kindex --got
3702@item --got=@var{type}
3703This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3704@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3705@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3706Info entry for @file{ld}.
3707
3708@end table
3709
3710@c man end
3711@end ifset
3712
833794fc
MR
3713@ifset MIPS
3714@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3715
3716@c man begin OPTIONS
3717
3718The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3719generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3720linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3721
3722@table @gcctabopt
3723
3724@kindex --insn32
3725@item --insn32
3726@kindex --no-insn32
3727@itemx --no-insn32
3728These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3729generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3730or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
373132-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3732used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3733possible.
3734
8b10b0b3
MR
3735@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3736@item --ignore-branch-isa
3737@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3738@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3739These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3740transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3741accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3742is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3743instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3744equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3745calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3746a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3747an error.
3748
3734320d
MF
3749@kindex --compact-branches
3750@item --compact-branches
3751@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3752@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3753These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3754in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3755
833794fc
MR
3756@end table
3757
3758@c man end
3759@end ifset
3760
fa1477dc
SC
3761
3762@ifset PDP11
3763@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3764
3765@c man begin OPTIONS
3766
3767For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3768produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3769for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3770targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3771defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3772here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3773
3774@table @gcctabopt
3775
3776@kindex -N
3777@item -N
3778@kindex --omagic
3779@itemx --omagic
3780
3781Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3782indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3783shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3784writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3785the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3786programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3787from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3788
3789@kindex -n
3790@item -n
3791@kindex --nmagic
3792@itemx --nmagic
3793
3794Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3795indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3796be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3797file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3798byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3799a @emph{pure executable} format.
3800
3801@kindex -z
3802@item -z
3803@kindex --imagic
3804@itemx --imagic
3805
3806Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3807indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3808data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3809instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3810larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3811to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3812shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3813option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3814and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3815this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3816executable} format.
3817
3818@kindex --no-omagic
3819@item --no-omagic
3820
3821Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3822
3823@end table
3824
3825@c man end
3826@end ifset
3827
252b5132
RH
3828@ifset UsesEnvVars
3829@node Environment
3830@section Environment Variables
3831
0285c67d
NC
3832@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3833
560e09e9 3834You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3835@ifclear SingleFormat
3836@code{GNUTARGET},
3837@end ifclear
3838@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3839
36f63dca 3840@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3841@kindex GNUTARGET
3842@cindex default input format
3843@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3844use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3845of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3846@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3847of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3848attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3849this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3850there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3851object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3852BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3853in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3854@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3855
3856@kindex LDEMULATION
3857@cindex default emulation
3858@cindex emulation, default
3859@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3860@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3861behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3862available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3863the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3864variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3865linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3866
3867@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3868@cindex demangling, default
3869Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3870@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3871default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3872a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3873may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3874options.
3875
0285c67d
NC
3876@c man end
3877@end ifset
3878
252b5132
RH
3879@node Scripts
3880@chapter Linker Scripts
3881
3882@cindex scripts
3883@cindex linker scripts
3884@cindex command files
3885Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3886written in the linker command language.
3887
3888The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3889the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3890the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3891more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3892direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3893described below.
3894
3895The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3896yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3897linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3898to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3899such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3900
3901You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3902line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3903default linker script.
3904
3905You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3906to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3907Linker Scripts}.
3908
3909@menu
3910* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3911* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3912* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3913* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3914* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3915* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3916* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3917* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3918* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3919* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3920* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3921@end menu
3922
3923@node Basic Script Concepts
3924@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3925@cindex linker script concepts
3926We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3927describe the linker script language.
3928
3929The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3930file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3931@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3932The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3933purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3934among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3935section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3936in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3937
3938Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3939also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3940contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3941the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3942A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3943area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3944loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3945which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3946of debugging information.
3947
3948Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3949first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3950the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3951@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3952section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3953same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3954is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3955(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3956based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3957RAM address would be the VMA.
3958
3959You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3960program with the @samp{-h} option.
3961
3962Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3963@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3964has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3965information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3966will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3967static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3968referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3969
3970You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3971program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3972option.
3973
3974@node Script Format
3975@section Linker Script Format
3976@cindex linker script format
3977Linker scripts are text files.
3978
3979You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3980either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3981symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3982generally ignored.
3983
3984Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3985If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3986otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3987double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3988file name.
3989
3990You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3991@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3992to whitespace.
3993
3994@node Simple Example
3995@section Simple Linker Script Example
3996@cindex linker script example
3997@cindex example of linker script
3998Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3999
4000The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
4001@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
4002memory layout of the output file.
4003
4004The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
4005describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
4006code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
4007@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
4008Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
4009your input files.
4010
4011For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
40120x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
4013linker script which will do that:
4014@smallexample
4015SECTIONS
4016@{
4017 . = 0x10000;
4018 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4019 . = 0x8000000;
4020 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4021 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
4022@}
4023@end smallexample
4024
4025You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
4026followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
4027descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
4028
252b5132
RH
4029The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
4030sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
4031counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
4032other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
4033current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
4034incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
4035@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
4036
4037The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
4038required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
4039after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
4040which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
4041wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
4042means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
4043
4044Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
4045@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
4046@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
4047
4048The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
4049the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
4050at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
4051output section, the value of the location counter will be
4052@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
4053effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 4054immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
4055
4056The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
4057alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
4058example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
4059sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
4060may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
4061sections.
4062
4063That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
4064
4065@node Simple Commands
4066@section Simple Linker Script Commands
4067@cindex linker script simple commands
4068In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
4069
4070@menu
4071* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
4072* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
4073@ifclear SingleFormat
4074* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
4075@end ifclear
4076
4a93e180 4077* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
4078* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
4079@end menu
4080
4081@node Entry Point
36f63dca 4082@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
4083@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
4084@cindex start of execution
4085@cindex first instruction
4086@cindex entry point
4087The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
4088point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
4089entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
4090@smallexample
4091ENTRY(@var{symbol})
4092@end smallexample
4093
4094There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
4095entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
4096stopping when one of them succeeds:
4097@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 4098@item
252b5132 4099the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 4100@item
252b5132 4101the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 4102@item
a094d01f 4103the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 4104targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 4105check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 4106@item
5226a6a8
NC
4107the address of the first byte of the code section, if present and an
4108executable is being created - the code section is usually
5c14cc55 4109@samp{.text}, but can be something else;
a1ab1d2a 4110@item
252b5132
RH
4111The address @code{0}.
4112@end itemize
4113
4114@node File Commands
36f63dca 4115@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
4116@cindex linker script file commands
4117Several linker script commands deal with files.
4118
4119@table @code
4120@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
4121@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
4122@cindex including a linker script
4123Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
4124be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 4125with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
412610 levels deep.
4127
4006703d
NS
4128You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
4129@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
4130
252b5132
RH
4131@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4132@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4133@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
4134@cindex input files in linker scripts
4135@cindex input object files in linker scripts
4136@cindex linker script input object files
4137The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
4138in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
4139
4140For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
4141a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
4142then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
4143
4144In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
4145script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
4146
e3f2db7f
AO
4147In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
4148with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
4149located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
4150for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
4151@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
4152filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
4153@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4154
4155If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
4156the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
4157found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
4158not found the linker will search through the archive library search
4159path.
252b5132 4160
ff5dcc92 4161If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 4162name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
4163@samp{-l}.
4164
4165When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
4166files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
4167script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
4168
4169@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4170@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4171@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
4172@cindex grouping input files
4173The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
4174files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
4175new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 4176in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 4177
b717d30e
JJ
4178@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4179@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4180@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
4181This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
4182commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
4183as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
4184with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
4185when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
4186@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
4187and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
4188setting afterwards.
4189
252b5132
RH
4190@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4191@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 4192@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
4193The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
4194@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
4195@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 4196Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
4197precedence.
4198
4199You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
4200output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
4201
4202@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4203@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4204@cindex library search path in linker script
4205@cindex archive search path in linker script
4206@cindex search path in linker script
4207The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 4208@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 4209@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 4210on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 4211are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 4212the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
4213
4214@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
4215@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
4216@cindex first input file
4217The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
4218that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
4219though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
4220when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
4221first file.
4222@end table
4223
4224@ifclear SingleFormat
4225@node Format Commands
36f63dca 4226@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
4227A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
4228
4229@table @code
4230@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4231@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4232@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4233@cindex output file format in linker script
4234The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4235output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 4236exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4237(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
4238line option takes precedence.
4239
4240You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 4241formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
4242This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4243desired endianness.
4244
4245If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4246will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4247output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4248used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4249
4250For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4251command:
4252@smallexample
4253OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4254@end smallexample
4255This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 4256@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
4257option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4258format.
4259
4260@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4261@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4262@cindex input file format in linker script
4263The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4264files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4265This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4266(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
4267is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4268command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4269@end table
4270@end ifclear
4271
4a93e180
NC
4272@node REGION_ALIAS
4273@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4274@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4275@cindex region alias
4276@cindex region names
4277
4278Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4279@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4280
4281@smallexample
4282REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4283@end smallexample
4284
4285The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4286memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4287to memory regions. An example follows.
4288
4289Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4290memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4291that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4292non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4293access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4294read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4295sections:
4296
4297@itemize @bullet
4298@item
4299@code{.text} program code;
4300@item
4301@code{.rodata} read-only data;
4302@item
4303@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4304@item
4305@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4306@end itemize
4307
4308The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4309part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4310output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4311systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4312@code{C}:
4313@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4314@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 4315@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
4316@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4317@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4318@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4319@end multitable
4320The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4321loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4322the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4323the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4324
4325The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4326includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4327memory layout:
4328@smallexample
4329INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4330
4331SECTIONS
4332 @{
4333 .text :
4334 @{
4335 *(.text)
4336 @} > REGION_TEXT
4337 .rodata :
4338 @{
4339 *(.rodata)
4340 rodata_end = .;
4341 @} > REGION_RODATA
4342 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4343 @{
4344 data_start = .;
4345 *(.data)
4346 @} > REGION_DATA
4347 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4348 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4349 .bss :
4350 @{
4351 *(.bss)
4352 @} > REGION_BSS
4353 @}
4354@end smallexample
4355
4356Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4357regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4358variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4359@table @code
4360@item A
4361Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4362@smallexample
4363MEMORY
4364 @{
4365 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4366 @}
4367
4368REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4369REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4370REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4371REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4372@end smallexample
4373@item B
4374Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4375into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4376@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4377@smallexample
4378MEMORY
4379 @{
4380 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4381 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4382 @}
4383
4384REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4385REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4386REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4387REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4388@end smallexample
4389@item C
4390Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4391@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4392initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4393system start into the @code{RAM}.
4394@smallexample
4395MEMORY
4396 @{
4397 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4398 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4399 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4400 @}
4401
4402REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4403REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4404REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4405REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4406@end smallexample
4407@end table
4408
4409It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4410@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4411necessary:
4412@smallexample
4413#include <string.h>
4414
4415extern char data_start [];
4416extern char data_size [];
4417extern char data_load_start [];
4418
4419void copy_data(void)
4420@{
4421 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4422 @{
4423 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4424 @}
4425@}
4426@end smallexample
4427
252b5132 4428@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 4429@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
4430There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4431
4432@table @code
4433@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4434@kindex ASSERT
4435@cindex assertion in linker script
4436Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4437with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4438
fd1c4238
NC
4439Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4440take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4441inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4442for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4443symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4444
4445@smallexample
4446 .stack :
4447 @{
4448 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4449 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4450 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4451 @}
4452@end smallexample
4453
4454will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4455PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4456can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4457
4458@smallexample
4459 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4460 .stack :
4461 @{
4462 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4463 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4464 @}
4465@end smallexample
4466
4467will work.
4468
252b5132
RH
4469@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4470@kindex EXTERN
4471@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4472Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4473symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4474modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4475each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4476command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4477
4478@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4479@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4480@cindex common allocation in linker script
4481This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4482to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4483output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4484
4818e05f
AM
4485@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4486@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4487@cindex common allocation in linker script
4488This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4489command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4490to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4491
7bdf4127
AB
4492@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4493@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4494@cindex group allocation in linker script
4495@cindex section groups
4496@cindex COMDAT
4497This command has the same effect as the
4498@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4499@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4500and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4501specified (@samp{-r}).
4502
53d25da6
AM
4503@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4504@kindex INSERT
4505@cindex insert user script into default script
4506This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4507augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4508inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4509@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4510default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4511sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4512linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4513insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4514linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4515default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4516of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4517to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4518is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4519
4520@smallexample
4521SECTIONS
4522@{
4523 OVERLAY :
4524 @{
4525 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4526 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4527 @}
4528@}
4529INSERT AFTER .text;
4530@end smallexample
4531
31f14901
AM
4532Note that when @samp{-T} is used twice, once to override the default
4533script and once to augment that script using @code{INSERT} the order
4534of parsing and section assignments apply as for the default script.
4535The script with @code{INSERT} should be specified @emph{first} on the
4536command line.
4537
252b5132
RH
4538@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4539@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4540@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4541This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4542references among certain output sections.
4543
4544In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4545using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4546will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4547errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4548a function defined in the other section.
4549
4550The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4551@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4552an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4553@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4554names.
4555
cdf96953
MF
4556@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4557@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4558@cindex cross references
4559This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4560references to one section from a list of other sections.
4561
4562The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4563output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4564a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4565there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4566must never call back.
4567
4568The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4569The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4570If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4571the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4572status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4573names, not input section names.
4574
252b5132
RH
4575@ifclear SingleFormat
4576@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4577@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4578@cindex machine architecture
4579@cindex architecture
4580Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4581of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4582architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4583the @samp{-f} option.
4584@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4585
4586@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4587@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4588This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4589@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4590in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4591@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4592@end table
4593
4594@node Assignments
4595@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4596@cindex assignment in scripts
4597@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4598@cindex variables, defining
4599You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4600the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4601
4602@menu
4603* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4604* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4605* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4606* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4607* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4608@end menu
4609
4610@node Simple Assignments
4611@subsection Simple Assignments
4612
4613You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4614
4615@table @code
4616@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4617@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4618@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4619@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4620@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4621@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4622@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4623@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4624@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4625@end table
4626
4627The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4628@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4629defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4630
4631The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4632may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4633
4634The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4635
4636Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4637
4638You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4639statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4640section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4641
4642The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4643expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4644
4645Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4646assignments may be used:
4647
4648@smallexample
4649floating_point = 0;
4650SECTIONS
4651@{
4652 .text :
4653 @{
4654 *(.text)
4655 _etext = .;
4656 @}
156e34dd 4657 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4658 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4659@}
4660@end smallexample
4661@noindent
4662In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4663zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4664the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4665defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4666upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4667
eb8476a6
MR
4668@node HIDDEN
4669@subsection HIDDEN
4670@cindex HIDDEN
4671For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4672exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4673
4674Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4675@code{HIDDEN}:
4676
4677@smallexample
4678HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4679SECTIONS
4680@{
4681 .text :
4682 @{
4683 *(.text)
4684 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4685 @}
4686 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4687 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4688@}
4689@end smallexample
4690@noindent
4691In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4692
252b5132
RH
4693@node PROVIDE
4694@subsection PROVIDE
4695@cindex PROVIDE
4696In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4697only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4698the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4699@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4700@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4701@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4702@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4703@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4704
4705Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4706@smallexample
4707SECTIONS
4708@{
4709 .text :
4710 @{
4711 *(.text)
4712 _etext = .;
4713 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4714 @}
4715@}
4716@end smallexample
4717
4718In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
3c27360b
JB
4719underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4720on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
252b5132
RH
4721underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4722If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4723linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4724
b0daac83
NC
4725Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4726defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4727that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4728when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4729@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4730
7af8e998
L
4731@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4732@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4733@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4734Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4735hidden and won't be exported.
4736
73ae6183
NC
4737@node Source Code Reference
4738@subsection Source Code Reference
4739
4740Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4741intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4742a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4743symbol that does not have a value.
4744
4745Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4746transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4747stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4748prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4749mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4750of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4751variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4752linker script variable might be referred to as:
4753
4754@smallexample
4755 extern int foo;
4756@end smallexample
4757
4758But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4759
4760@smallexample
4761 _foo = 1000;
4762@end smallexample
4763
4764In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4765transformation has taken place.
4766
4767When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4768things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4769in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4770second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4771table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4772contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4773value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4774
4775@smallexample
4776 int foo = 1000;
4777@end smallexample
4778
10bf6894 4779creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4780holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4781number 1000 is initially stored.
4782
4783When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4784first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4785memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4786So:
4787
4788@smallexample
4789 foo = 1;
4790@end smallexample
4791
4792looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4793associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4794address. Whereas:
4795
4796@smallexample
4797 int * a = & foo;
4798@end smallexample
4799
10bf6894 4800looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4801and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4802the variable @samp{a}.
4803
4804Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4805the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4806an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4807
4808@smallexample
4809 foo = 1000;
4810@end smallexample
4811
4812creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4813the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4814address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4815linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4816access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4817
4818Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4819you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4820use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4821section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4822linker script contains these declarations:
4823
4824@smallexample
4825@group
4826 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4827 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4828 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4829@end group
4830@end smallexample
4831
4832Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4833
4834@smallexample
4835@group
4836 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4837
73ae6183
NC
4838 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4839@end group
4840@end smallexample
4841
4842Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4843Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4844arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4845
4846@smallexample
4847@group
4848 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4849
4850 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4851@end group
4852@end smallexample
4853
4854Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4855operators.
73ae6183 4856
252b5132 4857@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4858@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4859@kindex SECTIONS
4860The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4861into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4862
4863The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4864@smallexample
4865SECTIONS
4866@{
4867 @var{sections-command}
4868 @var{sections-command}
4869 @dots{}
4870@}
4871@end smallexample
4872
4873Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4874
4875@itemize @bullet
4876@item
4877an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4878@item
4879a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4880@item
4881an output section description
4882@item
4883an overlay description
4884@end itemize
4885
4886The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4887@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4888those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4889understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4890the layout of the output file.
4891
4892Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4893below.
4894
4895If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4896linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4897section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4898input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4899example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4900in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4901
4902@menu
4903* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4904* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4905* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4906* Input Section:: Input section description
4907* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4908* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4909* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4910* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4911* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4912@end menu
4913
4914@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4915@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4916The full description of an output section looks like this:
4917@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4918@group
7e7d5768 4919@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4920 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4921 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4922 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4923 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4924 @{
4925 @var{output-section-command}
4926 @var{output-section-command}
4927 @dots{}
abc9061b 4928 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4929@end group
4930@end smallexample
4931
4932Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4933
4934The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4935name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4936The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4937the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4938The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4939
4940Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4941
4942@itemize @bullet
4943@item
4944a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4945@item
4946an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4947@item
4948data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4949@item
4950a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4951@end itemize
4952
4953@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4954@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4955@cindex name, section
4956@cindex section name
4957The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4958meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4959support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4960must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4961example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4962output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4963names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4964quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4965characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4966commas must be quoted.
4967
4968The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4969Discarding}.
4970
4971@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4972@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4973@cindex address, section
4974@cindex section address
4975The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4976address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4977is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4978
4979If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4980section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4981to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4982alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4983contained within the output section.
4984
4985The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4986
4987@itemize @bullet
4988@item
4989If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4990is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4991in that region.
4992
4993@item
4994If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4995regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4996section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4997be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4998
4999@item
5000If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
5001the output address will be based on the current value of the location
5002counter.
5003@end itemize
5004
5005@noindent
5006For example:
5007
252b5132
RH
5008@smallexample
5009.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
5010@end smallexample
ea5cae92 5011
252b5132
RH
5012@noindent
5013and
ea5cae92 5014
252b5132
RH
5015@smallexample
5016.text : @{ *(.text) @}
5017@end smallexample
ea5cae92 5018
252b5132
RH
5019@noindent
5020are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
5021@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
5022counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
5023counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
5024input sections.
252b5132
RH
5025
5026The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
5027For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
5028so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
5029do something like this:
5030@smallexample
5031.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
5032@end smallexample
5033@noindent
5034This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
5035aligned upward to the specified value.
5036
5037Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
5038location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
5039sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
5040
5041@node Input Section
36f63dca 5042@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
5043@cindex input sections
5044@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
5045The most common output section command is an input section description.
5046
5047The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
5048You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
5049in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
5050map the input files into your memory layout.
5051
5052@menu
5053* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
5054* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
5055* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
5056* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
5057* Input Section Example:: Input section example
5058@end menu
5059
5060@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 5061@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
5062@cindex input section basics
5063An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
5064by a list of section names in parentheses.
5065
5066The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
5067describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
5068
5069The most common input section description is to include all input
5070sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
5071include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
5072@smallexample
5073*(.text)
5074@end smallexample
5075@noindent
18625d54 5076Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 5077@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
5078of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
5079match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
5080example:
252b5132 5081@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
5082EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
5083@end smallexample
5084@noindent
5085will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
5086and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
5087placed inside the section list, for example:
5088@smallexample
b4346c09 5089*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 5090@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
5091@noindent
5092The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
5093two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
5094more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
5095
5096There are two ways to include more than one section:
5097@smallexample
5098*(.text .rdata)
5099*(.text) *(.rdata)
5100@end smallexample
5101@noindent
5102The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
5103@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
5104first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
5105they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
5106@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
5107@samp{.rdata} input sections.
5108
8f1732fc
AB
5109When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
5110is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
5111immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
5112@smallexample
5113*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
5114@end smallexample
5115@noindent
5116will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
5117@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
5118from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
5119exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 5120could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
5121@smallexample
5122*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
5123@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
5124@noindent
5125Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
5126before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
5127all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
5128@smallexample
5129EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
5130@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 5131
252b5132
RH
5132You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
5133You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
5134needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
5135@smallexample
5136data.o(.data)
5137@end smallexample
5138
ae17ab41
CM
5139To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
5140of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
5141
5142Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
5143
5144@smallexample
5145@group
5146SECTIONS @{
5147 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
5148 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
5149@}
5150@end group
5151@end smallexample
5152
5153In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
5154input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
5155@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
5156@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
5157whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
5158
967928e9
AM
5159You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
5160matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
5161with no whitespace around the colon.
5162
5163@table @samp
5164@item archive:file
5165matches file within archive
5166@item archive:
5167matches the whole archive
5168@item :file
5169matches file but not one in an archive
5170@end table
5171
5172Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
5173wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
5174single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
5175@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
5176within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
5177also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
5178other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
5179from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
5180command.
5181
252b5132
RH
5182If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
5183the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
5184commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
5185@smallexample
5186data.o
5187@end smallexample
5188
967928e9
AM
5189When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
5190and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
5191characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
5192name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
5193did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
5194though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
5195@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
5196the archive search path.
5197
5198@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 5199@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
5200@cindex input section wildcards
5201@cindex wildcard file name patterns
5202@cindex file name wildcard patterns
5203@cindex section name wildcard patterns
5204In an input section description, either the file name or the section
5205name or both may be wildcard patterns.
5206
5207The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
5208pattern for the file name.
5209
5210The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
5211
5212@table @samp
5213@item *
5214matches any number of characters
5215@item ?
5216matches any single character
5217@item [@var{chars}]
5218matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
5219character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
5220@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
5221@item \
5222quotes the following character
5223@end table
5224
252b5132
RH
5225File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
5226specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
5227does not search directories to expand wildcards.
5228
5229If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5230appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5231will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
5232sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5233@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5234@smallexample
5235.data : @{ *(.data) @}
5236.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5237@end smallexample
5238
bcaa7b3e 5239@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
5240Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5241in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
5242this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5243pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
5244@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
5245into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5246
bcaa7b3e 5247@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
5248@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5249@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5250alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5251alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5252needed.
bcaa7b3e 5253
02ecc8e9 5254@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
5255@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5256@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5257numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5258section name before placing them in the output file. In
5259@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5260the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5261@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 5262
bcaa7b3e
L
5263@cindex SORT
5264@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5265
85921e9a
NC
5266@cindex REVERSE
5267@code{REVERSE} indicates that the sorting should be reversed. If used
5268on its own then @code{REVERSE} implies @code{SORT_BY_NAME}, otherwise
5269it reverses the enclosed @code{SORT..} command. Note - reverse
5270sorting of alignment is not currently supported.
5271
5272Note - the sorting commands only accept a single wildcard pattern. So
5273for example the following will not work:
5274@smallexample
5275 *(REVERSE(.text* .init*))
5276@end smallexample
5277To resolve this problem list the patterns individually, like this:
5278@smallexample
5279 *(REVERSE(.text*))
5280 *(REVERSE(.init*))
5281@end smallexample
5282
5283Note - you can put the @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} command inside a sorting
5284command, but not the other way around. So for example:
5285@smallexample
5286 *(SORT_BY_NAME(EXCLUDE_FILE(foo) .text*))
5287@end smallexample
5288will work, but:
5289@smallexample
5290 *(EXCLUDE_FILE(foo) SORT_BY_NAME(.text*))
5291@end smallexample
5292will not.
5293
5294
bcaa7b3e
L
5295When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5296can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5297
5298@enumerate
5299@item
5300@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5301It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5302sections have the same name.
5303@item
5304@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5305It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5306sections have the same alignment.
5307@item
c0065db7 5308@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
5309treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5310@item
5311@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5312is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5313@item
85921e9a
NC
5314@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{REVERSE} (wildcard section pattern))
5315reverse sorts by name.
5316@item
5317@code{REVERSE} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern))
5318reverse sorts by name.
5319@item
5320@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} (@code{REVERSE} (wildcard section pattern))
5321reverse sorts by init priority.
5322@item
bcaa7b3e
L
5323All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5324@end enumerate
5325
a05a5b64 5326When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 5327section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 5328takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
5329
5330If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 5331command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
5332treated as nested sorting command.
5333
5334@enumerate
5335@item
5336@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5337@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5338@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5339@item
5340@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5341@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5342@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5343@end enumerate
5344
5345If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 5346command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 5347
eda680f8 5348@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 5349@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
5350section sorting option.
5351
252b5132
RH
5352If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5353@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5354precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5355
5356This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5357files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5358sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5359The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5360with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5361linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5362@smallexample
5363@group
5364SECTIONS @{
5365 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5366 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5367 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5368 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5369@}
5370@end group
5371@end smallexample
5372
5373@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 5374@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
5375@cindex common symbol placement
5376@cindex uninitialized data placement
5377A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5378file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5379linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5380named @samp{COMMON}.
5381
5382You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5383other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5384particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5385input files are placed in another section.
5386
5387In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5388@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5389@smallexample
5390.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5391@end smallexample
5392
5393@cindex scommon section
5394@cindex small common symbols
5395Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5396example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5397symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5398different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5399the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5400symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5401to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5402locations.
5403
5404@cindex [COMMON]
5405You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5406notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5407@samp{*(COMMON)}.
5408
5409@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 5410@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
5411@cindex KEEP
5412@cindex garbage collection
5413When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 5414it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
5415This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5416with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 5417@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
5418
5419@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 5420@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
5421The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5422to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5423start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5424@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5425follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5426@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5427@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5428All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5429files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5430
5431@smallexample
5432@group
5433SECTIONS @{
5434 outputa 0x10000 :
5435 @{
5436 all.o
5437 foo.o (.input1)
5438 @}
36f63dca
NC
5439@end group
5440@group
252b5132
RH
5441 outputb :
5442 @{
5443 foo.o (.input2)
5444 foo1.o (.input1)
5445 @}
36f63dca
NC
5446@end group
5447@group
252b5132
RH
5448 outputc :
5449 @{
5450 *(.input1)
5451 *(.input2)
5452 @}
5453@}
5454@end group
a1ab1d2a 5455@end smallexample
252b5132 5456
cbd0eecf
L
5457If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5458and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5459automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5460__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5461indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5462respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5463C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
75bd292b 5464
252b5132 5465@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 5466@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
5467@cindex data
5468@cindex section data
5469@cindex output section data
a4d5aec7 5470@kindex ASCIZ ``@var{string}''
252b5132
RH
5471@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5472@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5473@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5474@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5475@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5476You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5477@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5478an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5479parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5480value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5481counter.
5482
5483The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5484store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5485bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5486stored.
5487
5488For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5489of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5490@smallexample
5491BYTE(1)
5492LONG(addr)
5493@end smallexample
5494
5495When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5496same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5497target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5498@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5499@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5500
5501If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5502which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5503When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5504true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5505endianness of the first input object file.
5506
a4d5aec7
AM
5507You can include a zero-terminated string in an output section by using
5508@code{ASCIZ}. The keyword is followed by a string which is stored at
5509the current value of the location counter adding a zero byte at the
5510end. If the string includes spaces it must be enclosed in double
5511quotes. The string may contain '\n', '\r', '\t' and octal numbers.
5512Hex numbers are not supported.
5513
5514For example, this string of 16 characters will create a 17 byte area
5515@smallexample
5516 ASCIZ "This is 16 bytes"
5517@end smallexample
5518
36f63dca 5519Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5520between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5521@smallexample
5522SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5523@end smallexample
5524whereas this will work:
5525@smallexample
5526SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5527@end smallexample
75bd292b 5528
252b5132
RH
5529@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5530@cindex holes, filling
5531@cindex unspecified memory
5532You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5533current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5534otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5535gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5536with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5537necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5538point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5539than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5540different parts of an output section.
5541
5542This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5543value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5544@smallexample
563e308f 5545FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5546@end smallexample
5547
5548The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5549section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5550part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5551entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5552precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5553expression.
252b5132 5554
2d5783fa
NC
5555@kindex LINKER_VERSION
5556@cindex LINKER_VERSION
22bfda88
NC
5557The @code{LINKER_VERSION} command inserts a string containing the
5558version of the linker at the current point. Note - by default this
5559directive is disabled and will do nothing. It only becomes active if
5560the @option{--enable-linker-version} command line option is used.
2d5783fa
NC
5561
5562Built-in linker scripts for ELF based targets already include this
5563directive in their @samp{.comment} section.
5564
252b5132 5565@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5566@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5567There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5568commands.
5569
5570@table @code
5571@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5572@cindex input filename symbols
5573@cindex filename symbols
5574@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5575The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5576The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5577file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5578the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5579
5580This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5581normally used for any other object file format.
5582
5583@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5584@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5585@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5586@item CONSTRUCTORS
5587When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5588unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5589destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5590arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5591automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5592For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5593linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5594@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5595ignored for other object file formats.
5596
5597The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5598constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5599Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5600the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5601first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5602of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5603compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5604formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5605@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5606the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5607destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5608@code{exit}.
5609
5610For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5611arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5612addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5613and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5614linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5615runtime code expects to see.
5616
5617@smallexample
5618 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5619 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5620 *(.ctors)
5621 LONG(0)
5622 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5623 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5624 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5625 *(.dtors)
5626 LONG(0)
5627 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5628@end smallexample
5629
5630If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5631which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5632are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5633are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5634command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5635@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5636@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5637@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5638
5639Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5640and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5641need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5642scripts.
5643
5644@end table
5645
5646@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5647@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5648@cindex discarding sections
5649@cindex sections, discarding
5650@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5651The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5652This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5653may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5654@smallexample
49c13adb 5655.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5656@end smallexample
5657@noindent
5658will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5659@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5660sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5661space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5662too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5663space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5664@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5665@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5666This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5667
a0976ea4 5668The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5669on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5670symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5671the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5672section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5673
5674@cindex /DISCARD/
5675The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5676input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5677section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5678
99fabbc9
JL
5679This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5680@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5681garbage collection.
5682
a2e098c3
NC
5683Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5684discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5685members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5686Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5687
252b5132 5688@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5689@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5690@cindex output section attributes
5691We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5692like this:
0c71d759 5693
252b5132 5694@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5695@group
7e7d5768 5696@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5697 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5698 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5699 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5700 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5701 @{
5702 @var{output-section-command}
5703 @var{output-section-command}
5704 @dots{}
562d3460 5705 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5706@end group
5707@end smallexample
0c71d759 5708
252b5132
RH
5709We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5710@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5711remaining section attributes.
5712
a1ab1d2a 5713@menu
252b5132
RH
5714* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5715* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5716* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5717* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5718* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5719* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5720* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5721* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5722@end menu
5723
5724@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5725@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5726Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5727parentheses. The following types are defined:
5728
5729@table @code
dcb53d93 5730
252b5132
RH
5731@item NOLOAD
5732The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5733loaded into memory when the program is run.
dcb53d93 5734
6b86da53
LB
5735@item READONLY
5736The section should be marked as read-only.
dcb53d93 5737
252b5132 5738@item DSECT
c212f39d
FS
5739@item COPY
5740@item INFO
5741@item OVERLAY
252b5132
RH
5742These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5743rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5744marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5745section when the program is run.
dcb53d93 5746
c212f39d
FS
5747@item TYPE = @var{type}
5748Set the section type to the integer @var{type}. When generating an ELF
5749output file, type names @code{SHT_PROGBITS}, @code{SHT_STRTAB},
5c14cc55 5750@code{SHT_NOTE}, @code{SHT_NOBITS}, @code{SHT_INIT_ARRAY},
c212f39d
FS
5751@code{SHT_FINI_ARRAY}, and @code{SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY} are also allowed
5752for @var{type}. It is the user's responsibility to ensure that any
5753special requirements of the section type are met.
dcb53d93
NC
5754
5755Note - the TYPE only is used if some or all of the contents of the
5756section do not have an implicit type of their own. So for example:
5757@smallexample
5758 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ *(.bar) @}
5759@end smallexample
5760will set the type of section @samp{.foo} to the type of the section
5761@samp{.bar} in the input files, which may not be the SHT_PROGBITS
5762type. Whereas:
5763@smallexample
5764 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1) @}
5765@end smallexample
5766will set the type of @samp{.foo} to SHT_PROGBBITS. If it is necessary
5767to override the type of incoming sections and force the output section
5768type then an extra piece of untyped data will be needed:
5769@smallexample
5770 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1); *(.bar) @}
5771@end smallexample
5772
c212f39d
FS
5773@item READONLY ( TYPE = @var{type} )
5774This form of the syntax combines the @var{READONLY} type with the
5775type specified by @var{type}.
dcb53d93 5776
252b5132
RH
5777@end table
5778
5779@kindex NOLOAD
5780@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5781@cindex loading, preventing
5782The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5783the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5784the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5785@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5786need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5787@smallexample
5788@group
5789SECTIONS @{
5790 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5791 @dots{}
5792@}
5793@end group
5794@end smallexample
5795
5796@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5797@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5798@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5799@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5800@cindex load address
5801@cindex section load address
5802Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5803@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5804@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5805specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5806address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5807
ea5cae92
NC
5808The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5809specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5810takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5811load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5812region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5813
5814If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5815section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5816load address:
5817
5818@itemize @bullet
5819@item
5820If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5821the LMA address as well.
5822
5823@item
5824If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5825
5826@item
5827Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5828with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5829section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5830VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5831the last section in the located region.
5832
5833@item
5834If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5835that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5836
5837@item
5838If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5839section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5840@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5841
5842@cindex ROM initialized data
5843@cindex initialized data in ROM
5844This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5845example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5846called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5847@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5848even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5849uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5850defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5851counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5852
5853@smallexample
5854@group
5855SECTIONS
5856 @{
5857 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5858 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5859 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5860 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5861 .bss 0x3000 :
5862 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5863@}
5864@end group
5865@end smallexample
5866
5867The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5868this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5869the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5870how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5871script.
5872
5873@smallexample
5874@group
5875extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5876char *src = &_etext;
5877char *dst = &_data;
5878
ea5cae92
NC
5879/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5880while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5881 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5882
ea5cae92 5883/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5884for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5885 *dst = 0;
5886@end group
5887@end smallexample
5888
bbf115d3
L
5889@node Forced Output Alignment
5890@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5891@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5892@cindex forcing output section alignment
5893@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5894You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5895alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5896intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5897
7e7d5768
AM
5898@node Forced Input Alignment
5899@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5900@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5901@cindex forcing input section alignment
5902@cindex input section alignment
5903You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5904SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5905sections, whether larger or smaller.
5906
0c71d759
NC
5907@node Output Section Constraint
5908@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5909@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5910@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5911@cindex constraints on output sections
5912You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5913of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5914read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5915@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5916
252b5132 5917@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5918@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5919@kindex >@var{region}
5920@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5921@cindex memory regions and sections
5922You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5923using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5924
5925Here is a simple example:
5926@smallexample
5927@group
5928MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5929SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5930@end group
5931@end smallexample
5932
5933@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5934@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5935@kindex :@var{phdr}
5936@cindex section, assigning to program header
5937@cindex program headers and sections
5938You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5939using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5940one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5941assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5942@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5943linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5944
5945Here is a simple example:
5946@smallexample
5947@group
5948PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5949SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5950@end group
5951@end smallexample
5952
5953@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5954@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5955@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5956@cindex section fill pattern
5957@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5958You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5959@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5960(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5961within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5962alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5963necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5964of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5965an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5966fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5967other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5968pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5969expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5970
5971You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5972output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5973
5974Here is a simple example:
5975@smallexample
5976@group
563e308f 5977SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5978@end group
5979@end smallexample
5980
5981@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5982@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5983@kindex OVERLAY
5984@cindex overlays
5985An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5986are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5987the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5988copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5989required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5990can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5991than another.
5992
5993Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5994@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5995output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5996command is as follows:
5997@smallexample
5998@group
5999OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
6000 @{
6001 @var{secname1}
6002 @{
6003 @var{output-section-command}
6004 @var{output-section-command}
6005 @dots{}
6006 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
6007 @var{secname2}
6008 @{
6009 @var{output-section-command}
6010 @var{output-section-command}
6011 @dots{}
6012 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
6013 @dots{}
abc9061b 6014 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
6015@end group
6016@end smallexample
6017
6018Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
6019section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
6020section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 6021those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
6022except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
6023sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
6024
abc9061b
CC
6025The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
6026the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
6027
252b5132
RH
6028The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
6029addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
6030memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
6031whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
6032and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
6033and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
6034
56dd11f0
NC
6035If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
6036references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
6037the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
6038sense for one section to refer directly to another.
6039@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
6040
6041For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 6042provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
6043defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
6044@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
6045the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
6046within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
6047symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
6048
6049At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
6050the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
6051
6052Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
6053@code{SECTIONS} construct.
6054@smallexample
6055@group
6056 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
6057 @{
6058 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
6059 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
6060 @}
6061@end group
6062@end smallexample
6063@noindent
6064This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
6065address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
6066@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 6067following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
6068@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
6069@code{__load_stop_text1}.
6070
6071C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
6072like the following.
6073
6074@smallexample
6075@group
6076 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
6077 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
6078 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
6079@end group
6080@end smallexample
6081
6082Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
6083everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
6084example could have been written identically as follows.
6085
6086@smallexample
6087@group
6088 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
6089 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
6090 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 6091 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
6092 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
6093 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
6094 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
6095@end group
6096@end smallexample
6097
6098@node MEMORY
36f63dca 6099@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
6100@kindex MEMORY
6101@cindex memory regions
6102@cindex regions of memory
6103@cindex allocating memory
6104@cindex discontinuous memory
6105The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
6106memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
6107
6108The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
6109memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
6110may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
6111can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
6112set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
6113regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
6114around to fit into the available regions.
6115
127fcdff
AB
6116A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
6117however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
6118specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
6119@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
6120@smallexample
6121@group
a1ab1d2a 6122MEMORY
252b5132
RH
6123 @{
6124 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
6125 @dots{}
6126 @}
6127@end group
6128@end smallexample
6129
6130The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
6131region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
6132Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6133with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
6134must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
6135add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 6136command.
252b5132
RH
6137
6138@cindex memory region attributes
6139The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
6140whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
6141not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
6142@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
6143section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
6144the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
6145them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
6146
6147The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
6148@table @samp
6149@item R
6150Read-only section
6151@item W
6152Read/write section
6153@item X
6154Executable section
6155@item A
6156Allocatable section
6157@item I
6158Initialized section
6159@item L
6160Same as @samp{I}
6161@item !
c09e9a8c 6162Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
6163@end table
6164
81c688d5 6165If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 6166@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
6167attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
6168unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
6169not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
6170string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
6171or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
6172the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
6173
6174@kindex ORIGIN =
6175@kindex o =
6176@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
6177The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
6178the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
6179cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
6180abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
6181@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
6182
6183@kindex LENGTH =
6184@kindex len =
6185@kindex l =
6186The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
6187region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
6188be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
6189@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
6190
6191In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
6192available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
6193and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
6194linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
6195is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
6196or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
6197explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
6198region.
6199
6200@smallexample
6201@group
a1ab1d2a 6202MEMORY
252b5132
RH
6203 @{
6204 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
6205 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
6206 @}
6207@end group
6208@end smallexample
6209
6210Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
6211specific output sections into that memory region by using the
6212@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
6213a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
6214output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
6215was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
6216the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
6217output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
6218region, the linker will issue an error message.
6219
3ec57632 6220It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 6221expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
6222@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
6223
6224@smallexample
6225@group
c0065db7 6226 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
6227@end group
6228@end smallexample
6229
252b5132
RH
6230@node PHDRS
6231@section PHDRS Command
6232@kindex PHDRS
6233@cindex program headers
6234@cindex ELF program headers
6235@cindex program segments
6236@cindex segments, ELF
6237The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
6238@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
6239loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
6240program with the @samp{-p} option.
6241
6242When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
6243reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
6244program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
6245This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
6246interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
6247
6248The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
6249in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
6250precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
6251the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
6252not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
6253
6254The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
6255generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
6256ignore @code{PHDRS}.
6257
6258This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
6259@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
6260
6261@smallexample
6262@group
6263PHDRS
6264@{
6265 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
6266 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
6267@}
6268@end group
6269@end smallexample
6270
6271The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
6272of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
6273header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6274with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
6275must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
6276is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
6277
6278Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
6279system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
6280specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
6281sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
6282attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
6283Section Phdr}.
6284
6285It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
6286merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
6287repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
6288contain the section.
6289
6290If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
6291then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
6292not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
6293convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
6294placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
6295default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
6296segment at all.
6297
6298@kindex FILEHDR
6299@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 6300You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
6301the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
6302The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
6303file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 6304include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
6305segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
6306these keywords.
252b5132
RH
6307
6308The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
6309value of the keyword.
6310
6311@table @asis
6312@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
6313Indicates an unused program header.
6314
6315@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
6316Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
6317the file.
6318
6319@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
6320Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
6321
6322@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
6323Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
6324found.
6325
6326@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6327Indicates a segment holding note information.
6328
6329@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6330A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6331ABI.
6332
6333@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6334Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6335
1a9ccd70
NC
6336@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6337Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6338
252b5132
RH
6339@item @var{expression}
6340An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
6341be used for types not defined above.
6342@end table
6343
6344You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6345in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6346@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6347Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6348output section attribute.
6349
6350The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6351which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6352explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6353an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6354header.
6355
6356Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6357headers used on a native ELF system.
6358
6359@example
6360@group
6361PHDRS
6362@{
6363 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6364 interp PT_INTERP ;
6365 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6366 data PT_LOAD ;
6367 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6368@}
6369
6370SECTIONS
6371@{
6372 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6373 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6374 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6375 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6376 @dots{}
6377 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6378 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6379 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6380 @dots{}
6381@}
6382@end group
6383@end example
6384
6385@node VERSION
6386@section VERSION Command
6387@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6388@cindex symbol versions
6389@cindex version script
6390@cindex versions of symbols
6391The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6392only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6393symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6394a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6395shared library.
6396
6397You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6398you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6399also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6400
6401The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6402@smallexample
6403VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6404@end smallexample
6405
6406The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6407Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6408version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6409version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6410version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6411scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6412library.
6413
6414The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6415examples.
6416
6417@smallexample
6418VERS_1.1 @{
6419 global:
6420 foo1;
6421 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
6422 old*;
6423 original*;
6424 new*;
252b5132
RH
6425@};
6426
6427VERS_1.2 @{
6428 foo2;
6429@} VERS_1.1;
6430
6431VERS_2.0 @{
6432 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 6433 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 6434 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
6435 "f(int, double)";
6436 @};
252b5132
RH
6437@} VERS_1.2;
6438@end smallexample
6439
6440This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6441version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6442The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6443a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
6444of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6445symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6446is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6447in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
6448However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6449name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
6450
6451Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6452depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6453to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6454
6455Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6456depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6457and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6458
6459When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6460specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6461unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 6462unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
6463somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6464wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6465wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6466set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6467ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
6468
6469The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6470they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6471could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6472However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6473
0f6bf451 6474Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
6475in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6476symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6477won't.
6478
6479@smallexample
7c9c73be 6480@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 6481@end smallexample
6b9b879a 6482
252b5132
RH
6483When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6484symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6485requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6486shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6487loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6488linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6489application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6490way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6491all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6492search for each symbol reference.
6493
6494The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6495doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6496that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6497functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6498the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6499required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6500that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6501versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6502the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6503
6504There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6505first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6506source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6507script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6508maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6509@smallexample
6510__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6511@end smallexample
6512@noindent
6513in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6514be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6515The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
6516@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6517takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
6518
6519The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6520function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6521an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6522version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6523linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6524
6525To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6526source file. Here is an example:
6527
6528@smallexample
6529__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6530__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6531__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6532__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6533@end smallexample
6534
6535In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6536unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6537example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6538@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6539
6540When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6541some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6542this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6543@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6544declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6545you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6546
6547If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6548within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6549(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6550specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6551
cb840a31
L
6552You can also specify the language in the version script:
6553
6554@smallexample
6555VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6556@end smallexample
6557
c0065db7 6558The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6559The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6560demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6561patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6562@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6563
86043bbb
MM
6564Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6565described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6566or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6567the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6568whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6569cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6570might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6571should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6572expect when you upgrade.
6573
252b5132
RH
6574@node Expressions
6575@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6576@cindex expressions
6577@cindex arithmetic
6578The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
fb0afe4c
AM
6579that of C expressions, except that whitespace is required in some
6580places to resolve syntactic ambiguities. All expressions are
6581evaluated as integers. All expressions are evaluated in the same
6582size, which is 32 bits if both the host and target are 32 bits, and is
6583otherwise 64 bits.
252b5132
RH
6584
6585You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6586
6587The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6588expressions.
6589
6590@menu
6591* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6592* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6593* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6594* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6595* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6596* Operators:: Operators
6597* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6598* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6599* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6600@end menu
6601
6602@node Constants
6603@subsection Constants
6604@cindex integer notation
6605@cindex constants in linker scripts
6606All constants are integers.
6607
6608As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6609octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6610hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6611@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6612@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6613value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6614
6615@cindex scaled integers
6616@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6617@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6618@cindex suffixes for integers
6619@cindex integer suffixes
6620In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6621constant by
6622@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6623@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6624@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6625@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6626@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6627@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6628@tex
6629${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6630@end tex
6631@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6632respectively. For example, the following
6633all refer to the same quantity:
6634
252b5132 6635@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6636_fourk_1 = 4K;
6637_fourk_2 = 4096;
6638_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6639_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6640@end smallexample
6641
8a308ae8
NC
6642Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6643conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6644
0c71d759
NC
6645@node Symbolic Constants
6646@subsection Symbolic Constants
6647@cindex symbolic constants
6648@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6649It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6650the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6651
6652@table @code
6653@item MAXPAGESIZE
6654@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6655The target's maximum page size.
6656
6657@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6658@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6659The target's default page size.
6660@end table
6661
6662So for example:
6663
6664@smallexample
9d5777a3 6665 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6666@end smallexample
6667
6668will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6669supported by the target.
6670
252b5132
RH
6671@node Symbols
6672@subsection Symbol Names
6673@cindex symbol names
6674@cindex names
6675@cindex quoted symbol names
6676@kindex "
6677Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6678and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6679Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6680specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6681keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6682@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6683"SECTION" = 9;
6684"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6685@end smallexample
6686
6687Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6688to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6689whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6690
ecca9871
L
6691@node Orphan Sections
6692@subsection Orphan Sections
6693@cindex orphan
6694Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6695are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6696script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6697output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6698in which to place the orphaned input section.
6699
6700If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6701an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6702placed at the end of that output section.
6703
6704If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6705sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6706name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6707orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6708one new output section.
6709
6710If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6711then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6712in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6713linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6714attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6715sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6716support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6717
a05a5b64
TP
6718The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6719(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6720output sections an orphan is placed in.
6721
252b5132
RH
6722@node Location Counter
6723@subsection The Location Counter
6724@kindex .
6725@cindex dot
6726@cindex location counter
6727@cindex current output location
6728The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6729current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6730location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6731within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6732anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6733
6734@cindex holes
6735Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6736moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6737location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6738and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6739doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6740
6741@smallexample
6742SECTIONS
6743@{
6744 output :
6745 @{
6746 file1(.text)
6747 . = . + 1000;
6748 file2(.text)
6749 . += 1000;
6750 file3(.text)
563e308f 6751 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6752@}
6753@end smallexample
6754@noindent
6755In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6756located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6757followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6758@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6759@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6760specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6761
5c6bbab8
NC
6762@cindex dot inside sections
6763Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6764current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6765statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6766absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6767however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6768not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6769
6770@smallexample
6771SECTIONS
6772@{
6773 . = 0x100
6774 .text: @{
6775 *(.text)
6776 . = 0x200
6777 @}
6778 . = 0x500
6779 .data: @{
6780 *(.data)
6781 . += 0x600
6782 @}
6783@}
6784@end smallexample
6785
6786The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6787and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6788the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6789much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6790move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6791and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6792the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6793the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6794
b5666f2f
AM
6795@cindex dot outside sections
6796Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6797output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6798needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6799
6800@smallexample
6801SECTIONS
6802@{
6803 start_of_text = . ;
6804 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6805 end_of_text = . ;
6806
6807 start_of_data = . ;
6808 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6809 end_of_data = . ;
6810@}
6811@end smallexample
6812
6813If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6814not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6815between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6816should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6817blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6818the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6819sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6820statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6821special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6822place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6823as follows:
6824
6825@smallexample
6826SECTIONS
6827@{
6828 start_of_text = . ;
6829 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6830 end_of_text = . ;
6831
6832 start_of_data = . ;
6833 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6834 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6835 end_of_data = . ;
6836@}
6837@end smallexample
6838
6839This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6840@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6841placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6842assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6843a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6844section. So you could write:
6845
6846@smallexample
6847SECTIONS
6848@{
6849 start_of_text = . ;
6850 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6851 end_of_text = . ;
6852
6853 . = . ;
6854 start_of_data = . ;
6855 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6856 end_of_data = . ;
6857@}
6858@end smallexample
6859
6860Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6861@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6862
252b5132
RH
6863@need 2000
6864@node Operators
6865@subsection Operators
6866@cindex operators for arithmetic
6867@cindex arithmetic operators
6868@cindex precedence in expressions
6869The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6870the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6871@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6872@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6873@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6874@smallexample
b5c37946 6875precedence associativity Operators Notes
252b5132 6876(highest)
b5c37946 68771 left ! - ~ (1)
252b5132
RH
68782 left * / %
68793 left + -
68804 left >> <<
b5c37946
SJ
68815 left > < <= >=
68826 left == !=
68837 left &
68848 left ^
68859 left |
688610 left &&
688711 left ||
688812 right ? :
688913 right += -= *= /= <<= >>= &= |= ^= (2)
252b5132
RH
6890(lowest)
6891@end smallexample
6892Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6893(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6894(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6895@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6896@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6897@tex
6898\vskip \baselineskip
6899%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6900\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6901\hrule
6902\halign
6903{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6904height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6905&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6906height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6907\noalign{\hrule}
6908height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6909&highest&&&&&\cr
6910% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6911&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6912&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6913&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6914&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
b5c37946
SJ
6915&5&&left&& > < <= >=&\cr
6916&6&&left&&== !=&\cr
6917&7&&left&&\&&\cr
6918&8&&left&&\^{}&\cr
6919&9&&left&&|&\cr
6920&10&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6921&11&&left&&||&\cr
6922&12&&right&&? :&\cr
6923&13&&right&&\qquad += -= *= /= <<= >>= \&= |= \^{}=\qquad\ddag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6924&lowest&&&&&\cr
6925height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6926\hrule}
6927@end tex
6928@iftex
6929{
6930@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6931@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6932@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6933}
6934@end iftex
6935@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6936
6937@node Evaluation
6938@subsection Evaluation
6939@cindex lazy evaluation
6940@cindex expression evaluation order
6941The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6942an expression when absolutely necessary.
6943
6944The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6945address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6946regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6947as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6948
6949However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6950until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6951other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6952for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6953
6954The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6955assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6956allocation.
6957
6958Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6959@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6960
6961If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6962available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6963following
6964@smallexample
6965@group
6966SECTIONS
6967 @{
a1ab1d2a 6968 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6969 @{ *(.text) @}
6970 @}
6971@end group
6972@end smallexample
6973@noindent
6974will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6975address}.
6976
6977@node Expression Section
6978@subsection The Section of an Expression
6979@cindex expression sections
6980@cindex absolute expressions
6981@cindex relative expressions
6982@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6983@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6984@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6985Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6986relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6987using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6988value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6989symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6990operations.
6991
abf4be64
AM
6992Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6993section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6994address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6995@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6996functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6997One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6998(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6999differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
7000versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
7001section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
7002Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
7003absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
7004given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
7005everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
7006
7007In the following simple example,
252b5132 7008
7542af2a
AM
7009@smallexample
7010@group
7011SECTIONS
7012 @{
7013 . = 0x100;
7014 __executable_start = 0x100;
7015 .data :
7016 @{
7017 . = 0x10;
7018 __data_start = 0x10;
7019 *(.data)
7020 @}
7021 @dots{}
7022 @}
7023@end group
7024@end smallexample
252b5132 7025
7542af2a
AM
7026both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
7027address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
7028@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
7029section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 7030
5c3049d2
AM
7031For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
7032addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
7033
7034@itemize @bullet
7035@item
c05f749e
AM
7036Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
7037operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
7038absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
7039@item
7542af2a
AM
7040Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
7041relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
7042and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
7043@item
c05f749e
AM
7044Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
7045in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
7046address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
7047before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
7048@end itemize
7049
7050The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
7051
7052@itemize @bullet
7053@item
7054An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
7055@item
7056The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
7057@item
9bc8bb33 7058The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 7059relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
7060(after above conversions) is also a number when
7061@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
7062but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
7063@item
7064The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
7065relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
7066section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
7067@item
7068The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
7069conversions) is an absolute address.
7070@end itemize
252b5132
RH
7071
7072You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
7073to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
7074create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
7075section @samp{.data}:
7076@smallexample
7077SECTIONS
7078 @{
7079 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
7080 @}
7081@end smallexample
7082@noindent
7083If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
7084@samp{.data} section.
7085
7542af2a
AM
7086Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
7087particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
7088
252b5132
RH
7089@node Builtin Functions
7090@subsection Builtin Functions
7091@cindex functions in expressions
7092The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
7093use in linker script expressions.
7094
7095@table @code
7096@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
7097@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
7098@cindex expression, absolute
7099Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
7100of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
7101value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
7102normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
7103
7104@item ADDR(@var{section})
7105@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
7106@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 7107Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 7108script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
7109the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
7110@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
7111@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
7112the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
7113@smallexample
7114@group
7115SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7116 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 7117 @{
252b5132
RH
7118 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
7119 @dots{}
7120 @}
7121 .output :
7122 @{
7123 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
7124 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
7125 @}
7126@dots{} @}
7127@end group
7128@end smallexample
7129
876f4090
NS
7130@item ALIGN(@var{align})
7131@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
7132@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
7133@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
7134@cindex round up location counter
7135@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
7136@cindex round up expression
7137@cindex align expression
7138Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
7139to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
7140doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
7141arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
7142expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 7143equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
7144
7145Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
7146next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
7147variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
7148input sections:
252b5132
RH
7149@smallexample
7150@group
7151SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7152 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
7153 *(.data)
7154 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
7155 @}
7156@dots{} @}
7157@end group
7158@end smallexample
7159@noindent
7160The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
7161a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
7162a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
7163of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
7164
7165The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
7166
362c1d1a
NS
7167@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
7168@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
7169@cindex section alignment
7170Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
b5c37946
SJ
7171been allocated, or zero if the section has not been allocated. If the
7172section does not exist in the linker script the linker will report an
7173error. If @var{section} is @code{NEXT_SECTION} then @code{ALIGNOF} will
7174return the alignment of the next allocated section specified in the
7175linker script, or zero if there is no such section. In the following
7176example, the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the
7177first value in that section.
362c1d1a
NS
7178@smallexample
7179@group
7180SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7181 .output @{
7182 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
7183 @dots{}
7184 @}
7185@dots{} @}
7186@end group
7187@end smallexample
7188
252b5132
RH
7189@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
7190@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
7191This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
7192scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
7193section.
7194
2d20f7bf
JJ
7195@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
7196@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
7197This is equivalent to either
7198@smallexample
7199(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
7200@end smallexample
7201or
7202@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
7203(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
7204 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
7205@end smallexample
7206@noindent
7207depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
7208for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
7209@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
7210If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
7211memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
7212bytes in the on-disk file.
7213
7214This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
7215any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
7216@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
7217be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
7218running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
7219that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
7220page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
7221
7222@noindent
7223Example:
7224@smallexample
7225 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
7226@end smallexample
7227
7228@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7229@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7230This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
7231evaluation purposes.
7232
7233@smallexample
7234 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
7235@end smallexample
7236
a4f5ad88
JJ
7237@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7238@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7239This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 7240@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
7241When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
7242does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
7243@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
7244argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
7245script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
7246@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
7247padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
7248section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
7249
7250@smallexample
7251 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
7252@end smallexample
7253
252b5132
RH
7254@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7255@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7256@cindex symbol defaults
7257Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
7258defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
7259return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
7260default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
7261shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
7262the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
7263existed, its value is preserved:
7264
7265@smallexample
7266@group
7267SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7268 .text : @{
7269 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
7270 @dots{}
7271 @}
7272 @dots{}
7273@}
7274@end group
7275@end smallexample
7276
3ec57632
NC
7277@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
7278@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
7279Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7280
252b5132
RH
7281@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
7282@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
7283@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 7284Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
7285Section LMA}).
7286
2e53f7d6
NC
7287@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7288@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7289Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
7290@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
7291
252b5132
RH
7292@kindex MAX
7293@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7294Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7295
7296@kindex MIN
7297@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7298Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7299
7300@item NEXT(@var{exp})
7301@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
7302@cindex unallocated address, next
7303Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
7304This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
7305use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
7306output file, the two functions are equivalent.
7307
3ec57632
NC
7308@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7309@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7310Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7311
ba916c8a
MM
7312@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7313@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7314Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
7315value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
7316@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
7317will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
7318can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 7319``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
7320name.
7321
252b5132
RH
7322@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
7323@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
7324@cindex section size
7325Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
b5c37946
SJ
7326been allocated, or zero if the section has not been allocated. If the
7327section does not exist in the linker script the linker will report an
7328error. If @var{section} is @code{NEXT_SECTION} then @code{SIZEOF} will
7329return the alignment of the next allocated section specified in the
7330linker script, or zero if there is no such section. In the following
7331example, @code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical
7332values:
252b5132
RH
7333@smallexample
7334@group
7335SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7336 .output @{
7337 .start = . ;
7338 @dots{}
7339 .end = . ;
7340 @}
7341 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7342 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7343@dots{} @}
7344@end group
7345@end smallexample
7346
7347@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
252b5132
RH
7348@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7349@cindex header size
7350Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
7351information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
7352this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7353choose, to facilitate paging.
7354
7355@cindex not enough room for program headers
7356@cindex program headers, not enough room
7357When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7358@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7359number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7360addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7361additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7362room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7363the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7364script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7365you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7366command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7367@end table
7368
7369@node Implicit Linker Scripts
7370@section Implicit Linker Scripts
7371@cindex implicit linker scripts
7372If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7373an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7374linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7375linker will report an error.
7376
7377An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7378
7379Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7380assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7381commands.
7382
7383Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7384at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7385read. This can affect archive searching.
7386
bf6d8037
HC
7387@node Plugins
7388@chapter Linker Plugins
7389
7390@cindex plugins
7391@cindex linker plugins
7392The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7393For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7394support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7395
7396Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7397be added here later.
7398
9b38b85e 7399Plugins are enabled via the use of the @option{-plugin @var{name}}
3a117c58 7400command line option. @xref{Options}.
9b38b85e 7401
bf6d8037
HC
7402@menu
7403* libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7404@end menu
7405
7406@node libdep Plugin
7407@section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7408@cindex static library dependencies
7409Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7410just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7411optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7412within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7413rose to ascendance.
7414
7415One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7416multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7417dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7418library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7419referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7420link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7421libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7422explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7423
7424The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7425to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7426plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7427dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7428and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7429command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7430utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7431being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7432archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7433
7434For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7435library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7436the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7437
7438@smallexample
7439-L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7440@end smallexample
7441
252b5132
RH
7442@ifset GENERIC
7443@node Machine Dependent
7444@chapter Machine Dependent Features
7445
7446@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
7447@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7448sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
7449functionality are not listed.
7450
7451@menu
36f63dca
NC
7452@ifset H8300
7453* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7454@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
7455@ifset M68HC11
7456* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7457@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
7458@ifset ARM
7459* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7460@end ifset
7461@ifset HPPA
7462* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7463@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
7464@ifset M68K
7465* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7466@end ifset
833794fc
MR
7467@ifset MIPS
7468* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7469@end ifset
3c3bdf30 7470@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 7471* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 7472@end ifset
2469cfa2 7473@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 7474* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 7475@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
7476@ifset NDS32
7477* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7478@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
7479@ifset NIOSII
7480* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7481@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
7482@ifset POWERPC
7483* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7484@end ifset
7485@ifset POWERPC64
7486* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7487@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
7488@ifset S/390
7489* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7490@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
7491@ifset SPU
7492* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7493@end ifset
74459f0e 7494@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 7495* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 7496@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
7497@ifset WIN32
7498* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7499@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
7500@ifset XTENSA
7501* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7502@end ifset
252b5132
RH
7503@end menu
7504@end ifset
7505
252b5132
RH
7506@ifset H8300
7507@ifclear GENERIC
7508@raisesections
7509@end ifclear
7510
7511@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 7512@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
7513
7514@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 7515For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
7516you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7517
7518@table @emph
7519@cindex relaxing on H8/300
7520@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 7521@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
7522targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7523program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7524respectively.
7525
7526@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7527@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 7528@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 7529@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
7530sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7531page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7532(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7533@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7534top page of memory).
1502569c 7535
81f5558e
NC
7536@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7537indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7538displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7539the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7540@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7541whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7542range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7543
1502569c 7544@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 7545@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 7546biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 7547which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
7548page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7549(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 7550@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
7551the top page of memory).
7552
7553@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
7554@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
755532 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
7556changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7557(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 7558@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 7559the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
7560@end table
7561
7562@ifclear GENERIC
7563@lowersections
7564@end ifclear
7565@end ifset
7566
36f63dca 7567@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 7568@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 7569@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
7570@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7571@node Renesas
7572@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 7573
c2dcd04e
NC
7574@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7575H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7576options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
7577@end ifset
7578@end ifclear
7579
36f63dca
NC
7580@ifset ARM
7581@ifclear GENERIC
7582@raisesections
7583@end ifclear
7584
93fd0973
SC
7585@ifset M68HC11
7586@ifclear GENERIC
7587@raisesections
7588@end ifclear
7589
7590@node M68HC11/68HC12
7591@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7592
7593@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7594
7595@subsection Linker Relaxation
7596
7597For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7598optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7599
7600@table @emph
7601@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7602@item relaxing address modes
7603@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7604targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7605program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7606respectively.
7607
7608@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7609transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7610page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7611
7612@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7613When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7614of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7615addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7616@code{bset} instructions.
7617
7618@end table
7619
7620@subsection Trampoline Generation
7621
7622@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7623@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7624For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7625call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7626will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7627trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7628case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7629point to the function trampoline.
7630
7631@ifclear GENERIC
7632@lowersections
7633@end ifclear
7634@end ifset
7635
36f63dca 7636@node ARM
3674e28a 7637@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7638
7639@cindex ARM interworking support
7640@kindex --support-old-code
7641For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7642between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7643been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7644line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7645libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7646option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7647given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7648which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7649the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7650non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7651
7652@cindex thumb entry point
7653@cindex entry point, thumb
7654@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7655The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7656@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7657But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7658branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7659executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7660
ce11ba6c
KT
7661@cindex PE import table prefixing
7662@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7663The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7664the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7665element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7666import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7667
e489d0ae
PB
7668@cindex BE8
7669@kindex --be8
7670The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7671executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7672objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7673option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7674little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7675
3674e28a
PB
7676@cindex TARGET1
7677@kindex --target1-rel
7678@kindex --target1-abs
7679The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7680@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7681or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7682and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7683
7684@cindex TARGET2
7685@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7686The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7687@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7688meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7689@table @samp
7690@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7691@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7692@item abs
a57d1773 7693@samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
3674e28a
PB
7694@item got-rel
7695@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7696@end table
7697
319850b4
JB
7698@cindex FIX_V4BX
7699@kindex --fix-v4bx
7700The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7701specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7702interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7703also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7704
7705In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7706linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7707@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7708
7709In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7710relocations are ignored.
7711
845b51d6
PB
7712@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7713@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7714Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7715relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7716
7717@smallexample
7718TST rM, #1
7719MOVEQ PC, rM
7720BX Rn
7721@end smallexample
7722
7723This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7724and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7725condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7726
33bfe774
JB
7727@cindex USE_BLX
7728@kindex --use-blx
7729The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7730BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7731situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7732code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7733each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7734
c6dd86c6
JB
7735@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7736@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7737The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7738bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7739instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7740to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7741the support code can read the intended values.
7742
7743The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7744intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7745and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7746intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7747full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7748you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7749
7750If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7751enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7752@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7753mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7754vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7755@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7756
7757If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7758potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7759such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7760first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7761instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7762the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7763are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7764
2de70689
MGD
7765@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7766@kindex --fix-arm1176
7767@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7768The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7769in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7770are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7771unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7772
9d5777a3 7773Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7774Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7775http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7776
a504d23a
LA
7777@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7778@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7779
7780The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7781workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7782the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7783off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7784the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7785core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7786integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7787VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7788
7789The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7790necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7791
7792The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7793@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7794STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7795linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7796@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7797
7798If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7799potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7800such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7801replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7802branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7803then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7804
7805The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7806the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7807
7808The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7809they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7810there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7811occurs.
7812
7813The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7814PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7815large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7816cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7817occurs.
7818
bf21ed78
MS
7819@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7820@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7821The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7822warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7823enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7824linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7825using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7826not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7827
7828@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7829@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7830The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7831warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7832@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7833linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7834using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7835
726150b7
NC
7836@cindex PIC_VENEER
7837@kindex --pic-veneer
7838The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7839ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7840is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7841@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7842
7843@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7844@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7845The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7846code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7847perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7848placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7849controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7850The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7851duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7852group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7853code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7854where they should be placed.
7855
7856The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7857@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7858placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7859branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7860placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7861value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7862exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7863A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7864linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7865from the input sections.
7866
7867The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7868@samp{N = +1}.
7869
1a51c1a4
NC
7870Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7871only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7872otherwise.
7873
1db37fe6
YG
7874@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7875@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7876@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7877The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7878
7879The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7880
68fcca92
JW
7881@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7882@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7883@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7884The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7885
7886Please contact ARM for further details.
7887
1db37fe6
YG
7888@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7889@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7890@cindex Merging exidx entries
7891The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7892
7893@kindex --long-plt
7894@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7895The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7896which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7897entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7898
1f56df9d
JW
7899@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7900@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7901The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7902link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7903
4ba2ef8f
TP
7904@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7905All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7906Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7907@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7908veneers in memory.
7909
54ddd295
TP
7910@kindex --cmse-implib
7911@cindex Secure gateway import library
7912The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7913specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7914secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7915executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7916
0955507f
TP
7917@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7918@cindex Input import library
7919The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7920must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7921given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7922in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7923@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7924library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7925library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7926for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7927specified.
7928
36f63dca
NC
7929@ifclear GENERIC
7930@lowersections
7931@end ifclear
7932@end ifset
7933
7934@ifset HPPA
7935@ifclear GENERIC
7936@raisesections
7937@end ifclear
7938
7939@node HPPA ELF32
7940@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7941@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7942@kindex --multi-subspace
7943When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7944import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7945The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7946stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7947multiple sub-spaces.
7948
7949@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7950@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7951Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7952stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7953@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7954sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7955a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7956the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7957conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7958prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7959A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7960branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7961@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7962@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7963detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7964positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7965
7966Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7967single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7968create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7969large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7970
7971@ifclear GENERIC
7972@lowersections
7973@end ifclear
7974@end ifset
7975
7fb9f789
NC
7976@ifset M68K
7977@ifclear GENERIC
7978@raisesections
7979@end ifclear
7980
7981@node M68K
7982@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7983
7984@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7985@kindex --got=@var{type}
7986The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7987The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7988@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7989the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7990@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7991entries only at non-negative offsets.
7992@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7993entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7994support such GOTs.
7995@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7996output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7997file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7998files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7999
8000@ifclear GENERIC
8001@lowersections
8002@end ifclear
8003@end ifset
8004
833794fc
MR
8005@ifset MIPS
8006@ifclear GENERIC
8007@raisesections
8008@end ifclear
8009
8010@node MIPS
8011@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
8012
8013@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
8014@kindex --insn32
8015@kindex --no-insn32
8016The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
8017microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
8018in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
8019used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
8020or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
8021including 16-bit ones where possible.
8022
8b10b0b3
MR
8023@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
8024@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
8025@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
8026The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
8027control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
8028@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
8029relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
8030calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
8031relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
8032instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
8033or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
8034the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
8035
833794fc
MR
8036@ifclear GENERIC
8037@lowersections
8038@end ifclear
8039@end ifset
8040
36f63dca
NC
8041@ifset MMIX
8042@ifclear GENERIC
8043@raisesections
8044@end ifclear
8045
8046@node MMIX
8047@section @code{ld} and MMIX
8048For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
8049@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
8050understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
8051can translate between the two formats.
8052
8053There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
8054Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
8055registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
8056equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
8057@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
8058global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
8059this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
8060symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
8061
7a2de473
HPN
8062Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
8063@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
8064The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
8065of a section.
36f63dca
NC
8066
8067Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
8068are left out from an mmo file.
8069
8070@ifclear GENERIC
8071@lowersections
8072@end ifclear
8073@end ifset
8074
8075@ifset MSP430
8076@ifclear GENERIC
8077@raisesections
8078@end ifclear
8079
8080@node MSP430
8081@section @code{ld} and MSP430
8082For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
8083will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
8084just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
8085
8086@cindex MSP430 extra sections
8087The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
8088
8089@table @code
8090@item @samp{.vectors}
8091Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
8092
8093@item @samp{.bootloader}
8094Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
8095in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
8096
8097@item @samp{.infomem}
8098Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
8099this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
8100
c0065db7 8101@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
8102This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
8103in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
8104
8105@item @samp{.noinit}
8106Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
8107
c0065db7 8108The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
8109@end table
8110
7ef3addb
JL
8111@table @option
8112@cindex MSP430 Options
8113@kindex --code-region
8114@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
8115This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
8116argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
8117using this option.
8118
8119@kindex --data-region
8120@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
8121This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
8122[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
8123for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
8124
8125@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
8126@item --disable-sec-transformation
8127Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
8128and @code{--data-region} options.
8129This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
8130wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
8131not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
8132@end table
8133
36f63dca
NC
8134@ifclear GENERIC
8135@lowersections
8136@end ifclear
8137@end ifset
8138
35c08157
KLC
8139@ifset NDS32
8140@ifclear GENERIC
8141@raisesections
8142@end ifclear
8143
8144@node NDS32
8145@section @code{ld} and NDS32
8146@kindex relaxing on NDS32
8147For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
8148relaxes objects according to these options.
8149
8150@table @code
8151@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
8152Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
8153
8154@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
8155Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
8156
8157@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
8158Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
8159
8160@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
8161Export the EX9 table after linking.
8162
8163@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
8164Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
8165
8166@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
8167Update the existing EX9 table.
8168
8169@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
8170Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
8171
8172@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
8173Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
8174
8175@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
8176Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
8177
8178@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
8179Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
8180@end table
8181
8182@ifclear GENERIC
8183@lowersections
8184@end ifclear
8185@end ifset
8186
78058a5e
SL
8187@ifset NIOSII
8188@ifclear GENERIC
8189@raisesections
8190@end ifclear
8191
8192@node Nios II
8193@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
8194@cindex Nios II call relaxation
8195@kindex --relax on Nios II
8196
8197Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
8198transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
8199which may result in @command{ld} giving
8200@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8201The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
8202trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
8203outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
8204trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
8205be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
8206larger than 256MB.
8207
8208The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
8209is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
8210@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
8211locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
8212source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
8213register as a temporary.
8214
8215Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
8216relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
8217option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
8218
8219@ifclear GENERIC
8220@lowersections
8221@end ifclear
8222@end ifset
8223
2a60a7a8
AM
8224@ifset POWERPC
8225@ifclear GENERIC
8226@raisesections
8227@end ifclear
8228
8229@node PowerPC ELF32
8230@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
8231@cindex PowerPC long branches
8232@kindex --relax on PowerPC
8233Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
8234displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
8235@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8236@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
8237the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
8238section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
8239section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
8240@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
8241both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
8242considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
8243
8244@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
8245@table @option
8246@cindex PowerPC PLT
8247@kindex --bss-plt
8248@item --bss-plt
8249Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
8250generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
8251the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
8252writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
8253@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
8254PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
8255compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
8256BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
8257
016687f8
AM
8258@kindex --secure-plt
8259@item --secure-plt
8260@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
8261@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
8262when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
8263layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
8264style BSS PLT.
8265
2a60a7a8
AM
8266@cindex PowerPC GOT
8267@kindex --sdata-got
8268@item --sdata-got
8269The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
8270sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
8271@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
8272section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
8273@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
8274@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
8275@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
8276@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
8277PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
8278pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
8279GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
8280really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
8281
8282@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
8283@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8284@item --emit-stub-syms
8285This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8286symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8287
8288@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
8289@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8290@item --no-tls-optimize
8291PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8292sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8293disable the optimization.
8294@end table
8295
8296@ifclear GENERIC
8297@lowersections
8298@end ifclear
8299@end ifset
8300
8301@ifset POWERPC64
8302@ifclear GENERIC
8303@raisesections
8304@end ifclear
8305
8306@node PowerPC64 ELF64
8307@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
8308
8309@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
8310@table @option
8311@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
8312@kindex --stub-group-size
8313@item --stub-group-size
8314Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
8315by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
8316@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
8317sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
8318a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
8319the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
8320conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
8321prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
8322A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
8323branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
8324@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
8325@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
8326detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
8327positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
8328
8329Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
8330single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
8331create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
8332large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
8333
8334@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
8335@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8336@item --emit-stub-syms
8337This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8338symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8339
8340@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8341@kindex --dotsyms
8342@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
8343@item --dotsyms
8344@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
8345These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8346in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8347function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8348code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
8349properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8350to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
8351@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8352dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8353feature.
8354
7ae4ea7d
AM
8355@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8356@kindex --save-restore-funcs
8357@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
8358@item --save-restore-funcs
8359@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
8360These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8361provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8362@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8363function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8364link.
8365
2a60a7a8
AM
8366@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8367@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8368@item --no-tls-optimize
8369PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8370sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8371disable the optimization.
8372
7c9cf415
AM
8373@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8374@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8375@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
8376@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8377@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
8378@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8379@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 8380These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
8381stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8382an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8383@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
8384stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8385generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8386__tls_get_addr_opt.
8387Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8388much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8389an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8390will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8391@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8392and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8393this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8394Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 8395@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 8396register saves.
7c9cf415 8397
2a60a7a8
AM
8398@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8399@kindex --no-opd-optimize
8400@item --no-opd-optimize
8401PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8402corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 8403the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
8404Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8405
8406@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8407@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8408@item --non-overlapping-opd
8409Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8410@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8411the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8412entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8413
8414@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8415@kindex --no-toc-optimize
8416@item --no-toc-optimize
8417PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8418entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8419reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8420marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8421marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8422relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8423unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8424reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8425discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8426reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8427code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8428optimization.
8429
d882c988
AM
8430@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8431@kindex --no-inline-optimize
8432@item --no-inline-optimize
8433PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8434marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8435@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8436a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8437locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8438disables that optimization.
8439
2a60a7a8
AM
8440@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8441@kindex --no-multi-toc
8442@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
8443If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8444@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8445where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
8446entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8447total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8448grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8449TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8450calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8451help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
845264K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8453Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
8454
8455@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8456@kindex --no-toc-sort
8457@item --no-toc-sort
8458By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8459happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8460placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8461with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8462referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8463@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8464results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8465off this feature.
8466
8467@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8468@kindex --plt-align
8469@kindex --no-plt-align
8470@item --plt-align
8471@itemx --no-plt-align
8472Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
8473aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8474boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8475specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8476specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8477if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8478PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
8479
8480@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8481@kindex --plt-static-chain
8482@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8483@item --plt-static-chain
8484@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8485Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8486chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8487chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8488
8489@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8490@kindex --plt-thread-safe
8491@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8492@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 8493@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
8494With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8495lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8496another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8497order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8498memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8499barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8500looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8501seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8502default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
8503
8504@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8505@kindex --plt-localentry
8506@kindex --no-plt-localentry
8507@item --plt-localentry
8508@itemx --no-localentry
8509ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8510ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8511(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8512Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8513or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8514functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8515in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
8516interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8517including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8518to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8519complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8520care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
d882c988
AM
8521
8522@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8523@kindex --power10-stubs
8524@kindex --no-power10-stubs
8525@item --power10-stubs
8526@itemx --no-power10-stubs
8527When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8528relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
e10a07b3
AM
8529linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8530for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8531power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
d882c988
AM
8532power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8533allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
e10a07b3
AM
8534@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8535auto mode.
2a60a7a8
AM
8536@end table
8537
8538@ifclear GENERIC
8539@lowersections
8540@end ifclear
8541@end ifset
8542
b4cbbe8f
AK
8543@ifset S/390
8544@ifclear GENERIC
8545@raisesections
8546@end ifclear
8547
8548@node S/390 ELF
8549@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8550
8551@cindex S/390 ELF options
8552@table @option
8553
8554@cindex S/390
8555@kindex --s390-pgste
8556@item --s390-pgste
8557This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8558segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8559binaries marked that way.
8560@end table
8561
8562@ifclear GENERIC
8563@lowersections
8564@end ifclear
8565@end ifset
8566
49fa1e15
AM
8567@ifset SPU
8568@ifclear GENERIC
8569@raisesections
8570@end ifclear
8571
8572@node SPU ELF
8573@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8574
8575@cindex SPU ELF options
8576@table @option
8577
8578@cindex SPU plugins
8579@kindex --plugin
8580@item --plugin
8581This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8582
8583@cindex SPU overlays
8584@kindex --no-overlays
8585@item --no-overlays
8586Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8587regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8588@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8589turns off all this special overlay handling.
8590
8591@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8592@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8593@item --emit-stub-syms
8594This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8595symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8596
8597@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8598@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8599@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8600This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8601function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8602on calls to non-overlay regions.
8603
8604@cindex SPU local store size
8605@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8606@item --local-store=lo:hi
8607@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8608the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8609range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8610
c0065db7 8611@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8612@kindex --stack-analysis
8613@item --stack-analysis
8614SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8615unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8616under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8617@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8618@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8619determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8620for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8621for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8622for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8623find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8624and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8625under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8626dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8627is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8628and calls will be given.
8629
c0065db7 8630@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8631@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8632@item --emit-stack-syms
8633This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8634in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8635These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8636functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8637functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8638such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8639The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8640@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8641@end table
8642
8643@ifclear GENERIC
8644@lowersections
8645@end ifclear
8646@end ifset
8647
36f63dca
NC
8648@ifset TICOFF
8649@ifclear GENERIC
8650@raisesections
8651@end ifclear
8652
8653@node TI COFF
8654@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8655@cindex TI COFF versions
8656@kindex --format=@var{version}
8657The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8658TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8659also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8660format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8661header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8662
8663@ifclear GENERIC
8664@lowersections
8665@end ifclear
8666@end ifset
8667
2ca22b03
NC
8668@ifset WIN32
8669@ifclear GENERIC
8670@raisesections
8671@end ifclear
8672
8673@node WIN32
8674@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8675
c0065db7 8676This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8677See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8678command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8679
8680@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8681@cindex import libraries
8682@item import libraries
69da35b5 8683The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8684libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8685regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8686archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8687support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8688@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8689
d1792f72
NC
8690@item Resource only DLLs
8691It is possible to create a DLL that only contains resources, ie just a
8692@samp{.rsrc} section, but in order to do so a custom linker script
8693must be used. This is because the built-in default linker scripts
05d31a0b 8694will always create @samp{.text} and @samp{.idata} sections, even if
d1792f72
NC
8695there is no input to go into them.
8696
8697The script should look like this, although the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT}
8698should be changed to match the desired format.
8699
8700@example
8701OUTPUT_FORMAT(pei-i386)
8702SECTIONS
8703@{
8704 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
8705 . = ALIGN(__section_alignment__);
8706 .rsrc __image_base__ + __section_alignment__ : ALIGN(4)
8707 @{
8708 KEEP (*(.rsrc))
8709 KEEP (*(.rsrc$*))
8710 @}
8711 /DISCARD/ : @{ *(*) @}
8712@}
8713@end example
8714
8715With this script saved to a file called, eg @file{rsrc.ld}, a command
8716line like this can be used to create the resource only DLL
8717@file{rsrc.dll} from an input file called @file{rsrc.o}:
8718
8719@smallexample
8720ld -dll --subsystem windows -e 0 -s rsrc.o -o rsrc.dll -T rsrc.ld
8721@end smallexample
8722
c0065db7
RM
8723@item exporting DLL symbols
8724@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8725The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8726
8727@table @emph
8728@item using auto-export functionality
8729@cindex using auto-export functionality
8730By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8731which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8732
0a5d968e
NC
8733@itemize
8734@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8735@item --exclude-symbols
8736@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8737@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8738@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8739@end itemize
8740
09e2aba4
DK
8741When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8742(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8743symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8744often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8745private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8746options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8747exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8748final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8749
8750If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8751command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8752if either of the following are true:
8753
8754@itemize
8755@item A DEF file is used.
8756@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8757@end itemize
dc8465bf 8758
c0065db7
RM
8759@item using a DEF file
8760@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8761Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8762an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8763exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8764name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8765command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8766
8767@example
8768gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8769@end example
8770
0a5d968e
NC
8771Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8772@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8773
dc8465bf
NC
8774Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8775
8776@example
4b5bd4e7 8777LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8778
8779EXPORTS
8780foo
8781bar
8782_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8783another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8784var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8785doo = foo == foo2
8786eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8787@end example
dc8465bf 8788
7fcab871 8789This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8790symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8791alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8792by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8793@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8794@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8795export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8796in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8797symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8798
6b31ad16
DS
8799The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8800name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8801the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8802
b45619c0
NC
8803When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8804library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8805@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8806executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8807
8808With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8809specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8810non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8811
8812If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8813or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8814filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8815
4b5bd4e7
DS
8816The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8817
8818@example
8819EXPORTS
8820 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8821 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8822 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8823@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8824
8825Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8826@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8827@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8828@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8829Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8830@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8831string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8832
8833The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8834
8835@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8836will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8837by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8838linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8839library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8840
8841@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8842The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8843the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8844@code{*_imp__foo}).
8845
8846@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8847well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8848read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8849variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8850the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8851extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8852application will behave unexpectedly.
8853
8854@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8855it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8856symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8857API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8858the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8859
4b5bd4e7
DS
8860See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8861other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8862
8863@cindex creating a DEF file
8864While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8865with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8866
8867@item Using decorations
8868@cindex Using decorations
8869Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8870itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8871declared as:
8872
8873@example
8874__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8875__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8876@end example
8877
8878All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8879any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8880this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8881the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8882
8883Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8884decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8885instead:
8886
8887@example
8888__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8889__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8890@end example
8891
c0065db7
RM
8892This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8893when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8894variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8895code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8896of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8897omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8898@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8899information.
c0065db7 8900@end table
dc8465bf 8901
2ca22b03
NC
8902@cindex automatic data imports
8903@item automatic data imports
8904The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8905by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8906compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8907issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8908code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8909c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8910initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8911decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8912platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8913command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8914The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8915suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8916trigger the feature's use.
8917
c0065db7 8918auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8919additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8920
c0065db7 8921"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8922documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8923
c0065db7
RM
8924The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8925occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8926One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8927below.
8928
8929@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8930For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8931object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8932offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8933field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8934in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8935without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8936The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8937references.
8938
c0065db7
RM
8939The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8940be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8941themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8942runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8943compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8944support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8945run without error on an older system.
8946
c0065db7
RM
8947@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8948enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8949
8950@cindex direct linking to a dll
8951@item direct linking to a dll
8952The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8953including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8954libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8955traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8956libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8957function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8958though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8959storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8960tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8961large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8962
c0065db7 8963Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8964@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8965of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8966perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8967select the dll instead of an import library.
8968
2ca22b03 8969
69da35b5
NC
8970For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8971to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8972
8973@example
45e948fe
NC
8974libxxx.dll.a
8975xxx.dll.a
8976libxxx.a
8977xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8978libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8979cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8980libxxx.dll
8981xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8982@end example
8983
69da35b5
NC
8984before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8985
c0065db7
RM
8986(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8987where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8988@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8989file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8990@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8991
c0065db7
RM
8992Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8993@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8994was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8995various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8996could coexist on the same machine.
8997
2ca22b03
NC
8998The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8999applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 9000libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
9001
9002@example
9003bin/
9004 cygxxx.dll
9005lib/
9006 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 9007 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
9008@end example
9009
c0065db7
RM
9010Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
9011done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
9012
90131. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
9014@example
9015gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 9016@end example
2ca22b03 9017
69da35b5
NC
9018However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
9019(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
9020@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
9021not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
9022
2ca22b03
NC
90232. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
9024directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
9025should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
9026making the app/dll.
9027
9028@example
9029ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 9030@end example
2ca22b03
NC
9031
9032Then you can link without any make environment changes.
9033
9034@example
9035gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 9036@end example
69da35b5
NC
9037
9038This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
9039perfectly legal
9040
9041@example
9042bin/
9043 cygxxx-5.dll
9044lib/
c0065db7 9045 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
9046@end example
9047
dc8465bf 9048Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
9049even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
9050@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
9051
9052Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 9053wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
9054
90551. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
9056work with auto-imported data.
9057
dc8465bf
NC
90582. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
9059import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
9060symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
9061for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
9062possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 9063
45e948fe
NC
90643. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
9065critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
9066in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
9067stdcall-decorated assembly names.
9068
69da35b5 9069So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
9070true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
9071a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
9072binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
9073massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
9074requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
9075will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 9076
c0065db7 9077@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 9078@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
9079@item adding additional names
9080Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
9081A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
9082exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
9083when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 9084import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 9085
c0065db7 9086@example
dc8465bf
NC
9087LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
9088
9089EXPORTS
c0065db7 9090foo
dc8465bf 9091_foo = foo
c0065db7 9092@end example
dc8465bf
NC
9093
9094The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
9095
9096Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
9097source code using the "weak" attribute:
9098
c0065db7
RM
9099@example
9100void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 9101void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 9102@end example
dc8465bf
NC
9103
9104See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
9105symbols.
9106
9107@item renaming symbols
9108Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 9109kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
9110@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
9111DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 9112created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 9113
c0065db7 9114@example
dc8465bf
NC
9115LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
9116
9117EXPORTS
9118_foo = foo
c0065db7 9119@end example
dc8465bf
NC
9120
9121The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
9122@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 9123@end table
dc8465bf 9124
0a5d968e 9125Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 9126unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 9127If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
9128@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
9129that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
9130@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
9131renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
9132to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
9133the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
9134In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 9135which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
9136
9137@cindex weak externals
9138@item weak externals
9139The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
9140weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
9141defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
9142are three variants of weak externals:
9143@itemize
9144@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
9145called lazy externals.
9146@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
9147This form is not presently implemented.
9148@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
9149implemented.
9150@end itemize
9151As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
9152are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
9153uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
9154
9155@cindex aligned common symbols
9156@item aligned common symbols
9157As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
9158desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
9159the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
9160carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
9161by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
9162tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
9163but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
9164warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 9165
2ca22b03
NC
9166@end table
9167
9168@ifclear GENERIC
9169@lowersections
9170@end ifclear
9171@end ifset
9172
e0001a05
NC
9173@ifset XTENSA
9174@ifclear GENERIC
9175@raisesections
9176@end ifclear
9177
9178@node Xtensa
9179@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
9180
9181@cindex Xtensa processors
9182The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
9183@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
9184specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
9185keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
9186example, with the command:
9187
9188@smallexample
9189SECTIONS
9190@{
9191 .text : @{
9192 *(.literal .text)
9193 @}
9194@}
9195@end smallexample
9196
9197@noindent
9198@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
9199and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
9200literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
9201interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
9202group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
9203files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
9204and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 9205
43cd72b9 9206@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 9207@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
9208Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
9209provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
9210is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
9211literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
9212will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
9213location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
9214the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
9215unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
9216@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
9217range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
9218
9219For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
9220to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
9221instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
9222instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
9223instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
9224@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
9225hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
9226By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
9227switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
9228density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
9229instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
9230performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
9231linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
9232a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
9233
9234The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
9235control the linker:
9236
9237@cindex Xtensa options
9238@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
9239@item --size-opt
9240When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
9241more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
9242no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
9243alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
9244preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
9245
9246@item --abi-windowed
9247@itemx --abi-call0
9248Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
9249PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
9250because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
9251conventions.
9252Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
9253of the first input object.
9254A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
9255or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 9256@end table
e0001a05
NC
9257
9258@ifclear GENERIC
9259@lowersections
9260@end ifclear
9261@end ifset
9262
252b5132
RH
9263@ifclear SingleFormat
9264@node BFD
9265@chapter BFD
9266
9267@cindex back end
9268@cindex object file management
9269@cindex object formats available
9270@kindex objdump -i
9271The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
9272These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
9273object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
9274format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
9275it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
9276associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
9277object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
9278(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
9279list all the formats available for your configuration.
9280
9281@cindex BFD requirements
9282@cindex requirements for BFD
9283As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
9284several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
9285BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
9286formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
9287been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
9288BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
9289may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
9290
9291One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
9292mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
9293useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
9294conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
9295
9296@menu
9297* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
9298@end menu
9299
9300@node BFD outline
36f63dca 9301@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
9302@cindex opening object files
9303@include bfdsumm.texi
9304@end ifclear
9305
9306@node Reporting Bugs
9307@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
9308@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
9309@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 9310
ff5dcc92 9311Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
9312
9313Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
9314it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 9315to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 9316work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 9317@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
9318
9319In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
9320information that enables us to fix the bug.
9321
9322@menu
9323* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
9324* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
9325@end menu
9326
9327@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 9328@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
9329@cindex bug criteria
9330
9331If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
9332
9333@itemize @bullet
9334@cindex fatal signal
9335@cindex linker crash
9336@cindex crash of linker
9337@item
9338If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 9339@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
9340
9341@cindex error on valid input
9342@item
ff5dcc92 9343If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
9344
9345@cindex invalid input
9346@item
ff5dcc92 9347If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
9348may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
9349object files are correct.
9350
9351@item
9352If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 9353improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
9354@end itemize
9355
9356@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 9357@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 9358@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 9359@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
9360
9361A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 9362products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
9363recommend you contact that organization first.
9364
9365You can find contact information for many support companies and
9366individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
9367distribution.
9368
ad22bfe8 9369@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 9370Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
9371@value{BUGURL}.
9372@end ifset
252b5132
RH
9373
9374The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9375@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
9376fact or leave it out, state it!
9377
9378Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9379problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
9380assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9381matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
9382the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9383location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9384were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9385into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
9386specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 9387and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
9388
9389Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9390the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9391on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
9392
9393Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
9394bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9395respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9396You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
9397
9398To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9399
9400@itemize @bullet
9401@item
ff5dcc92 9402The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
9403the @samp{--version} argument.
9404
9405Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 9406the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
9407
9408@item
ff5dcc92 9409Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
9410patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9411
9412@item
9413The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9414version number.
9415
9416@item
ff5dcc92 9417What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
9418``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9419
9420@item
9421The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9422observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9423list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9424sufficient.
9425
9426If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9427and then we might not encounter the bug.
9428
9429@item
9430A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
9431bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9432provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9433bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9434state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9435requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9436we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9437attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
9438
9439If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9440@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9441object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9442@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9443how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9444
9445@item
9446A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9447incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9448
ff5dcc92 9449Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
9450will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9451not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9452a chance to make a mistake.
9453
9454Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9455say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 9456copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
9457C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9458and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9459fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9460you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9461any conclusion from our observations.
9462
9463@item
ff5dcc92 9464If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
9465diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9466@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 9467If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
9468context, not by line number.
9469
9470The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9471sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9472@end itemize
9473
9474Here are some things that are not necessary:
9475
9476@itemize @bullet
9477@item
9478A description of the envelope of the bug.
9479
9480Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9481which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9482changes will not affect it.
9483
9484This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9485will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9486with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9487We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9488
9489Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9490of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9491output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9492less time, and so on.
9493
9494However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9495report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9496
9497@item
9498A patch for the bug.
9499
9500A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9501the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9502a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9503to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9504
ff5dcc92 9505Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
9506construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9507through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9508able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9509fixed.
9510
9511And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9512patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9513help us to understand.
9514
9515@item
9516A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9517
9518Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9519things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9520@end itemize
9521
9522@node MRI
9523@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9524@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
9525To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9526linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
9527alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9528described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9529simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 9530@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
9531linker commands; these commands are described here.
9532
9533In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9534file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9535features to make use of them.
9536
9537You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9538@samp{-c} command-line option.
9539
9540Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9541command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9542blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 9543MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9544issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9545
9546Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9547
9548You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9549lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9550The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9551
9552@table @code
9553@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9554@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9555@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9556Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
9557the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9558@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9559your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9560script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9561commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9562input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9563@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9564
9565@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9566@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9567Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9568in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9569
9570@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9571
9572@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9573@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9574Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9575@var{expression} should be a power of two.
9576
9577@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9578@item BASE @var{expression}
9579Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9580absolute addresses) in the output file.
9581
9582@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9583@item CHIP @var{expression}
9584@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9585This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9586
9587@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9588@item END
9589This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9590
9591@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9592@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9593Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 9594language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
9595
9596@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9597@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9598Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 9599@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
9600
9601The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9602same line, with no change in its effect.
9603
9604@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9605@item LOAD @var{filename}
9606@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9607Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 9608same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9609command line.
9610
9611@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9612@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 9613@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
9614MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9615option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9616
9617@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9618@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9619@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9620Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
9621order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9622script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9623sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9624file, in the order specified.
9625
9626@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9627@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9628@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9629@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9630Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9631@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9632
9633@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9634@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9635@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9636@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9637You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9638specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9639If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9640@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9641@end table
9642
793c5807
NC
9643@node GNU Free Documentation License
9644@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 9645@include fdl.texi
704c465c 9646
370b66a1
CD
9647@node LD Index
9648@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
9649
9650@printindex cp
9651
9652@tex
7ca01ed9 9653% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
9654% meantime:
9655\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9656\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9657\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9658\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9659\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9660\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9661\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9662\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9663\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9664% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9665@end tex
9666
252b5132 9667@bye